blob: 00a5238e114529bf656f536a4243a6a8a1723c63 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau02c7c142012-06-04 00:43:45 +02007 2012/06/04
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100565. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020057
586. HTTP header manipulation
59
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100607. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200617.1. Matching integers
627.2. Matching strings
637.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200647.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200657.5. Available matching criteria
667.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
677.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
687.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
697.6. Pre-defined ACLs
707.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100717.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020072
738. Logging
748.1. Log levels
758.2. Log formats
768.2.1. Default log format
778.2.2. TCP log format
788.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100798.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200808.3. Advanced logging options
818.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
828.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
838.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
848.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
858.4. Timing events
868.5. Session state at disconnection
878.6. Non-printable characters
888.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
898.8. Capturing HTTP headers
908.9. Examples of logs
91
929. Statistics and monitoring
939.1. CSV format
949.2. Unix Socket commands
95
96
971. Quick reminder about HTTP
98----------------------------
99
100When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
101fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
102on almost anything found in the contents.
103
104However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
105formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
106correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
107
108
1091.1. The HTTP transaction model
110-------------------------------
111
112The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100113to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
115connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
116will involve a new connection :
117
118 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
119
120In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
121establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
122by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
123length.
124
125Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
126to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
127however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
128response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
129header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
130
131 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
132
133Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
134power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
135but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200136a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137
138A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
139keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
140second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
141page :
142
143 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
144
145This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
146latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
147correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
148the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100149server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
152connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
153everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
154established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
155sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
156while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
157another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
158sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
159http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
160mode.
161
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162
1631.2. HTTP request
164-----------------
165
166First, let's consider this HTTP request :
167
168 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100169 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
171 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
172 3 User-agent: my small browser
173 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
174 5 Accept: image/png
175
176
1771.2.1. The Request line
178-----------------------
179
180Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
181
182 - a METHOD : GET
183 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
184 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
185
186All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
187which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
188followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
189is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
190desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
191the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
192
193The URI itself can have several forms :
194
195 - A "relative URI" :
196
197 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
198
199 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
200 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
201
202 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
203
204 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
205
206 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
207 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
208 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
209 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
210 must accept this form too.
211
212 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
213 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
214 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100215
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
217 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
218 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
219 other protocols too.
220
221In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
222mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
223on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
224It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
225specific to the language, framework or application in use.
226
227
2281.2.2. The request headers
229--------------------------
230
231The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
232beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
233an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
234Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
235values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
236encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
237the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
238define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
239
240Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
241their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
242"Connection:" header).
243
244The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
245that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
246is one valid form of empty line.
247
248Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
249headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
250about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
251application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
252
253Important note:
254 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
255 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
256 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
257 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
258
259
2601.3. HTTP response
261------------------
262
263An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
264messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
265
266 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100267 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200268 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
269 2 Content-length: 350
270 3 Content-Type: text/html
271
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200272As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
273codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
274response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100275continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
276the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
277following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
278sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
279(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
280correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
281such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
282state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
283over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
284if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
285information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
2881.3.1. The Response line
289------------------------
290
291Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
292
293 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
294 - a status code : 200
295 - a reason : OK
296
297The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200298 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
300 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
301 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
302 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
303
304Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100305"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
307messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
308or "Authentication Required".
309
310Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
311
312 Code When / reason
313 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
314 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
316 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
317 400 for an invalid or too large request
318 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
319 accessing the stats page)
320 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
321 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
322 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
323 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
324 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
325 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
326 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
327 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
328 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
329
330The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3314.2).
332
333
3341.3.2. The response headers
335---------------------------
336
337Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
338the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
339details.
340
341
3422. Configuring HAProxy
343----------------------
344
3452.1. Configuration file format
346------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200347
348HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
349
350 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
351 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
352 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
353 "frontend" and "backend".
354
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100355The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
356referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
357delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100358preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100359escaped by doubling them.
360
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
3622.2. Time format
363----------------
364
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100365Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100366values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
367otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
368numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
369for every keyword. Supported units are :
370
371 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
372 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
373 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
374 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
375 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
376 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
377
378
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003792.3. Examples
380-------------
381
382 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
383 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
384 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
385 global
386 daemon
387 maxconn 256
388
389 defaults
390 mode http
391 timeout connect 5000ms
392 timeout client 50000ms
393 timeout server 50000ms
394
395 frontend http-in
396 bind *:80
397 default_backend servers
398
399 backend servers
400 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
401
402
403 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
404 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
405 global
406 daemon
407 maxconn 256
408
409 defaults
410 mode http
411 timeout connect 5000ms
412 timeout client 50000ms
413 timeout server 50000ms
414
415 listen http-in
416 bind *:80
417 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
418
419
420Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
421
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100422 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200423
424
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004253. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200426--------------------
427
428Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
429are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
430of them have command-line equivalents.
431
432The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
433
434 * Process management and security
435 - chroot
436 - daemon
437 - gid
438 - group
439 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100440 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200441 - nbproc
442 - pidfile
443 - uid
444 - ulimit-n
445 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200446 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200447 - node
448 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100449 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100450
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200451 * Performance tuning
452 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200453 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100454 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 - noepoll
456 - nokqueue
457 - nopoll
458 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100459 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200460 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200461 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200462 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200463 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100464 - tune.maxaccept
465 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200466 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200467 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100468 - tune.rcvbuf.client
469 - tune.rcvbuf.server
470 - tune.sndbuf.client
471 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100472
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200473 * Debugging
474 - debug
475 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200476
477
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004783.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200479------------------------------------
480
481chroot <jail dir>
482 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
483 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
484 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
485 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
486 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
487 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100488
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200489daemon
490 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
491 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
492 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
493
494gid <number>
495 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
496 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
497 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
498 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100499
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200500group <group name>
501 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
502 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100503
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200504log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200505 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
506 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100507 configured with "log global".
508
509 <address> can be one of:
510
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100511 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100512 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
513 port).
514
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100515 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
516 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
517 port).
518
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100519 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
520 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
521 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
522 writeable).
523
524 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200525
526 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
527 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
528 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
529
530 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200531 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
532 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
533 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
534 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
535 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
536 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200538 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200539
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100540log-send-hostname [<string>]
541 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
542 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
543 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
544 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
545 the logs.
546
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000547log-tag <string>
548 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
549 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
550 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
551 running on the same host.
552
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200553nbproc <number>
554 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
555 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
556 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
557 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
558 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
559
560pidfile <pidfile>
561 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
562 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
563 starting the process. See also "daemon".
564
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200565stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>]
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200566 [level <level>]
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200567
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200568 Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously
569 existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100570 will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200571 issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
572
573 An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of
574 the commands that can be issued on the socket :
575 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
576 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
577 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
578
579 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +0200580 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200581 counters).
582
583 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
584 all counters).
Willy Tarreaua8efd362008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100585
586 On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this
587 socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and
588 group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to
589 restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode"
590 keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on
591 the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the
592 user the process is started with.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200593
594stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
595 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
596 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100597 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200598
599stats maxconn <connections>
600 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
601 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
602
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200603uid <number>
604 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
605 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
606 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
607 one. See also "gid" and "user".
608
609ulimit-n <number>
610 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
611 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
612 option.
613
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100614unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
615 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
616
617 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
618 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
619 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
620 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
621 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
622 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
623 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
624 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
625 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
626 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
627
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200628user <user name>
629 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
630 See also "uid" and "group".
631
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200632node <name>
633 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
634
635 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
636 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
637 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
638 traffic.
639
640description <text>
641 Add a text that describes the instance.
642
643 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
644 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
645 "<" and ">" characters.
646
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200647
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006483.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200649-----------------------
650
651maxconn <number>
652 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
653 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
654 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
655 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
656
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200657maxconnrate <number>
658 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
659 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
660 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
661 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
662 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
663 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
664 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
665 fairness.
666
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100667maxpipes <number>
668 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
669 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
670 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
671 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
672 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
673 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
674
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200675noepoll
676 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
677 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
678 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
679
680nokqueue
681 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
682 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
683 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
684
685nopoll
686 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
687 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100688 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200689 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
690 "nokqueue".
691
692nosepoll
693 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
694 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
695 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
696
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100697nosplice
698 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
699 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
700 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100701 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100702 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
703 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
704 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
705 "option splice-response".
706
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200707spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
708 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
709 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
710 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
711 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
712 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
713
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200714tune.bufsize <number>
715 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
716 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
717 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
718 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
719 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
720 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
721 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
722 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
723
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200724tune.chksize <number>
725 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
726 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
727 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
728 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
729 checks whenever possible.
730
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200731tune.http.maxhdr <number>
732 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
733 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
734 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
735 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
736 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
737 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
738 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
739 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
740 limit too high.
741
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100742tune.maxaccept <number>
743 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
744 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
745 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100746 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100747 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
748 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100749 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100750 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
751
752tune.maxpollevents <number>
753 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
754 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
755 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
756 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
757 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
758
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200759tune.maxrewrite <number>
760 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
761 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
762 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
763 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
764 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
765 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
766 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
767 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
768 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
769 bufsize.
770
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200771tune.pipesize <number>
772 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
773 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
774 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
775 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
776 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
777 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
778
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100779tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
780tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
781 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
782 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
783 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
784 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
785 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
786 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
787 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
788
789tune.sndbuf.client <number>
790tune.sndbuf.server <number>
791 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
792 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
793 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
794 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
795 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
796 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
797 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
798 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
799 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
800 notifying haproxy again.
801
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200802
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008033.3. Debugging
804--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200805
806debug
807 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
808 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
809 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
810 system startup.
811
812quiet
813 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
814 line argument "-q".
815
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200816
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008173.4. Userlists
818--------------
819It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
820http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
821it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
822
823userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100824 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100825 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
826
827group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100828 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100829 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
830 proceeded by "users" keyword.
831
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100832user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
833 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100834 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
835 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100836 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
837 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100838 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
839 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
840
841
842 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100843 userlist L1
844 group G1 users tiger,scott
845 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100846
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100847 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
848 user scott insecure-password elgato
849 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100850
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100851 userlist L2
852 group G1
853 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100854
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100855 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
856 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
857 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100858
859 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200860
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200861
8623.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200863----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200864It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
865haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
866pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
867identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
868or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
869Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
870known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
871the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
872process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
873during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
874tables.
875
876peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400877 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200878 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
879
880peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
881 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
882 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
883 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
884 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
885 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
886 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
887
888 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
889 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
890
891 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
892 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
893 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
894 across all peers.
895
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200896 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200897 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100898 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
899 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
900 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200901
902 backend mybackend
903 mode tcp
904 balance roundrobin
905 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
906 stick on src
907
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100908 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
909 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200910
911
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009124. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200913----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100914
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200915Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
916 - defaults <name>
917 - frontend <name>
918 - backend <name>
919 - listen <name>
920
921A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
922its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
923section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100924section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200925
926A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
927connections.
928
929A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
930to forward incoming connections.
931
932A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
933parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
934
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100935All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
936'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
937case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
938
939Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
940logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
941proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
942However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
943name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
944
945Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
946and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100947bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100948protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
949modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
950arbitrary criteria.
951
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100952
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
954--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200956The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
957limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
958they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
959limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100960marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200961option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200962and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
963with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
964specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100965
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200966
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100967 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
968------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
969acl - X X X
970appsession - - X X
971backlog X X X -
972balance X - X X
973bind - X X -
974bind-process X X X X
975block - X X X
976capture cookie - X X -
977capture request header - X X -
978capture response header - X X -
979clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
980contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
981cookie X - X X
982default-server X - X X
983default_backend X X X -
984description - X X X
985disabled X X X X
986dispatch - - X X
987enabled X X X X
988errorfile X X X X
989errorloc X X X X
990errorloc302 X X X X
991-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
992errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200993force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100994fullconn X - X X
995grace X X X X
996hash-type X - X X
997http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100998http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200999http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001000http-request - X X X
1001id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001002ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001003log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001004maxconn X X X -
1005mode X X X X
1006monitor fail - X X -
1007monitor-net X X X -
1008monitor-uri X X X -
1009option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1010option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1011option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1012option allbackups (*) X - X X
1013option checkcache (*) X - X X
1014option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1015option contstats (*) X X X -
1016option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1017option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1018option forceclose (*) X X X X
1019-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1020option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001021option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001022option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001023option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1024option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1025option httpchk X - X X
1026option httpclose (*) X X X X
1027option httplog X X X X
1028option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001029option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001030option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001031option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1032option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1033option logasap (*) X X X -
1034option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001035option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001036option nolinger (*) X X X X
1037option originalto X X X X
1038option persist (*) X - X X
1039option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001040option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001041option smtpchk X - X X
1042option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1043option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1044option splice-request (*) X X X X
1045option splice-response (*) X X X X
1046option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1047option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1048-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1049option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1050option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1051option tcpka X X X X
1052option tcplog X X X X
1053option transparent (*) X - X X
1054persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1055rate-limit sessions X X X -
1056redirect - X X X
1057redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1058redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1059reqadd - X X X
1060reqallow - X X X
1061reqdel - X X X
1062reqdeny - X X X
1063reqiallow - X X X
1064reqidel - X X X
1065reqideny - X X X
1066reqipass - X X X
1067reqirep - X X X
1068reqisetbe - X X X
1069reqitarpit - X X X
1070reqpass - X X X
1071reqrep - X X X
1072-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1073reqsetbe - X X X
1074reqtarpit - X X X
1075retries X - X X
1076rspadd - X X X
1077rspdel - X X X
1078rspdeny - X X X
1079rspidel - X X X
1080rspideny - X X X
1081rspirep - X X X
1082rsprep - X X X
1083server - - X X
1084source X - X X
1085srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001086stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001087stats auth X - X X
1088stats enable X - X X
1089stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001090stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001091stats realm X - X X
1092stats refresh X - X X
1093stats scope X - X X
1094stats show-desc X - X X
1095stats show-legends X - X X
1096stats show-node X - X X
1097stats uri X - X X
1098-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1099stick match - - X X
1100stick on - - X X
1101stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001102stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001103stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001104tcp-request connection - X X -
1105tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001106tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001107tcp-response content - - X X
1108tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001109timeout check X - X X
1110timeout client X X X -
1111timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1112timeout connect X - X X
1113timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1114timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1115timeout http-request X X X X
1116timeout queue X - X X
1117timeout server X - X X
1118timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1119timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001120timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001121transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001122unique-id-format X X X -
1123unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001124use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001125use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001126------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1127 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001128
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011304.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1131---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001132
1133This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1134
1135
1136acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1137 Declare or complete an access list.
1138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1139 no | yes | yes | yes
1140 Example:
1141 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1142 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1143 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1144
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001145 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001146
1147
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001148appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1149 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001150 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1152 no | no | yes | yes
1153 Arguments :
1154 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1155 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1156
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001157 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001158 checked in each cookie value.
1159
1160 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1161 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1162 milliseconds.
1163
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001164 request-learn
1165 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1166 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1167 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1168 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1169 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1170 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1171
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001172 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1173 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1174 data following this prefix.
1175
1176 Example :
1177 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1178
1179 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1180 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1181
1182 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1183 2 modes are currently supported :
1184 - path-parameters :
1185 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1186 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1187 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1188 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1189 - query-string :
1190 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1191 query string.
1192
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001193 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1194 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1195 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1196 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001197 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1198 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1199 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001200 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1201 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1202
1203 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1204
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001205 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1206 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1207 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1208
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001209 Example :
1210 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1211
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001212 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1213 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001214
1215
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001216backlog <conns>
1217 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1219 yes | yes | yes | no
1220 Arguments :
1221 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1222 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001223 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001224
1225 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1226 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1227 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1228 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1229 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1230 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1231 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1232 backlog parameter.
1233
1234 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1235 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1236 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1237
1238 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1239
1240
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001241balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001242balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001243 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1245 yes | no | yes | yes
1246 Arguments :
1247 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1248 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1249 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1250 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1251
1252 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1253 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1254 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1255 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001256 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1257 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1258 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1259 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1260 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1261 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1262 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1263 it, so that you don't worry.
1264
1265 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1266 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1267 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1268 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1269 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1270 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1271 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1272 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001273
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001274 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1275 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1276 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1277 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1278 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1279 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1280 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1281 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1282
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001283 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1284 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1285 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1286 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001287 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001288 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1289 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1290 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1291 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1292 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001293 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1294 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1295 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1296 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1297 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1298 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001299
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001300 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1301 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1302 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1303 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1304 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1305 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1306 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1307 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001308 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001309 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001310 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1311 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1312 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001313
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001314 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1315 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1316 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1317 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1318 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1319 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1320 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1321 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1322 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1323 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1324 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1325 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001326
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001327 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001328 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1329 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1330 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1331 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1332 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1333 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1334 URIs start with a leading "/".
1335
1336 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1337 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1338 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1339 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1340
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001341 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001342 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1343
1344 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001345 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1346 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1347 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1348 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1349 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1350 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1351 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1352 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1353 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1354 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1355 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1356 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1357 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1358 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1359 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1360 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1361 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1362 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1363 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001364
1365 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1366 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1367 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1368 server will receive the request.
1369
1370 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1371 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1372 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1373 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1374 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001375 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1376 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1377 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001378
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001379 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1380 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1381 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1382 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1383 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001384
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001385 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001386 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1387 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1388 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1389
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001390 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1391 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1392 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1393
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001394 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001395 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001396 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1397 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1398 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1399 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1400 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1401 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001402 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001403 used instead.
1404
1405 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1406 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1407 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1408 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1409
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001410 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1411 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1412 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1413
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001414 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001415
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001416 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001417 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1418 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001419
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001420 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001421 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001422
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001423 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1424 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1425 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001426
1427 Examples :
1428 balance roundrobin
1429 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001430 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001431 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1432 balance hdr(host)
1433 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001434
1435 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1436 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1437
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001438 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001439 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1440 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1441 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1442 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1443
1444 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1445 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1446 defaults to 16 kB.
1447
1448 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1449 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1450
1451 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1452 Round Robin.
1453
1454 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1455 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1456 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1457 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1458
1459 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1460
1461 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001462 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001463 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1464 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1465 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001466
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001467 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1468 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001469
1470
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001471bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...]
1472bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface>
1473bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg>
Willy Tarreau32368ce2012-09-06 11:10:55 +02001474bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] backlog <backlog>
1475bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001476bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent
1477bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id>
1478bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name>
1479bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001480bind /<path> [, ...]
1481bind /<path> [, ...] mode <mode>
1482bind /<path> [, ...] [ user <user> | uid <uid> ]
1483bind /<path> [, ...] [ group <user> | gid <gid> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001484 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1486 no | yes | yes | no
1487 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001488 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1489 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1490 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1491 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001492 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001493
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001494 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1495 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001496 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1497 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1498 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001499 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1500 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1501 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1502 the range.
1503
1504 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1505 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1506 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1507 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1508 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1509 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1510 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001511 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001512 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001513
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001514 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1515 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1516 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1517 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1518 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1519 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1520 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1521 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1522
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001523 <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently
1524 only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical
1525 interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all
1526 addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the
1527 incoming packet physically come through the designated
1528 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to
1529 the same address if they are bound to different interfaces.
1530 Note that binding to a physical interface requires root
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001531 privileges. This parameter is only compatible with TCP
1532 sockets.
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001533
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001534 <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be
1535 advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force
1536 a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for
1537 connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001538 kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux
1539 but was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may
1540 not work on other operating systems. It may also not change
1541 the advertised value but change the effective size of
1542 outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value on Ethernet
1543 networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
1544 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is
1545 negative, it will indicate by how much to reduce the incoming
1546 connection's advertised MSS for outgoing segments. This
1547 parameter is only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001548
Willy Tarreau32368ce2012-09-06 11:10:55 +02001549 <backlog> sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the
1550 frontend's backlog is used instead.
1551
1552 <maxconn> limits the socket to this number of concurrent connections.
1553 Extra connections will remain in the system's backlog until a
1554 connection is released. If unspecified, the limit will be the
1555 same as the frontend's maxconn. Note that in case of port
1556 ranges, the same value will be applied to each socket. This
1557 setting enables different limitations on expensive sockets,
1558 for instance SSL entries which may easily eat all memory.
1559
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02001560 <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and
1561 unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be
1562 assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a
1563 single socket.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001564
1565 <name> is an optional name provided for stats
1566
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001567 <mode> is the octal mode used to define access permissions on the
1568 UNIX socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1569 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1570 simply ignore this.
1571
1572 <user> is the name of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1573 socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1574 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1575 simply ignore this.
1576
1577 <group> is the name of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1578 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1579 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1580 this.
1581
1582 <uid> is the uid of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1583 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1584 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1585 this.
1586
1587 <gid> is the gid of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1588 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1589 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1590 this.
1591
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001592 transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
1593 Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound
1594 even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001595 targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001596 the address was locally configured. This normally requires
1597 that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with
1598 the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for
1599 the specified port. This keyword is available only when
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001600 HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1. This parameter is
1601 only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001602
Willy Tarreau59f89202010-10-02 11:54:00 +02001603 defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
Willy Tarreaucb6cd432009-10-13 07:34:14 +02001604 Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be
1605 accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the
1606 first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for
1607 which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly
1608 improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is
1609 already available when the connection is accepted. On the
1610 other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which
1611 don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
1612 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is
1613 never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues
1614 with front firewalls which would see an established
1615 connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV.
1616
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001617 accept-proxy is an optional keyword which enforces use of the PROXY
1618 protocol over any connection accepted by this listener. The
1619 PROXY protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of the
1620 incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used,
1621 with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules
1622 which will only see the real connection address. Logs will
1623 reflect the addresses indicated in the protocol, unless it is
1624 violated, in which case the real address will still be used.
1625 This keyword combined with support from external components
1626 can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
1627 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and
1628 not even always usable.
1629
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001630 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1631 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1632 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1633 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1634 in a frontend.
1635
1636 Example :
1637 listen http_proxy
1638 bind :80,:443
1639 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001640 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001641
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001642 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001643 documentation.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001644
1645
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001646bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1647 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1649 yes | yes | yes | yes
1650 Arguments :
1651 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1652 may be used to override a default value.
1653
1654 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1655 option may be combined with other numbers.
1656
1657 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1658 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1659 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1660 missing from all processes.
1661
1662 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1663 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1664 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1665 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1666
1667 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1668 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1669 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1670 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1671 and 'even' instances.
1672
1673 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1674 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1675 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1676 32.
1677
1678 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1679 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1680
1681 Example :
1682 listen app_ip1
1683 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001684 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001685
1686 listen app_ip2
1687 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001688 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001689
1690 listen management
1691 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001692 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001693
1694 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1695
1696
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001697block { if | unless } <condition>
1698 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1700 no | yes | yes | yes
1701
1702 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1703 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001704 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001705 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001706 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1707 "block" statements per instance.
1708
1709 Example:
1710 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1711 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1712 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1713 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1714
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001715 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001716
1717
1718capture cookie <name> len <length>
1719 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1721 no | yes | yes | no
1722 Arguments :
1723 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1724 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1725 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1726 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1727 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1728
1729 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1730 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1731 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1732 right if it exceeds <length>.
1733
1734 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1735 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1736 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1737 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1738
1739 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1740 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1741 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1742
1743 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1744 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1745 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1746 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001747 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001748 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1749
1750 Example:
1751 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1752
1753 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001754 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001755
1756
1757capture request header <name> len <length>
1758 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1760 no | yes | yes | no
1761 Arguments :
1762 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001763 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001764 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1765 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1766 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1767
1768 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1769 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1770 it exceeds <length>.
1771
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001772 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001773 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1774 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001775 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1776 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1777 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1778 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001779 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001780 environments to find where the request came from.
1781
1782 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1783 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1784 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1785 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001786
1787 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1788 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1789 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1790 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1791
1792 Example:
1793 capture request header Host len 15
1794 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1795 capture request header Referrer len 15
1796
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001797 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001798 about logging.
1799
1800
1801capture response header <name> len <length>
1802 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1804 no | yes | yes | no
1805 Arguments :
1806 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001807 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001808 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1809 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1810 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1811
1812 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1813 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1814 it exceeds <length>.
1815
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001816 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001817 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1818 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1819 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001820 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1821 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1822 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1823 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001824
1825 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1826 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1827 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1828 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1829
1830 Example:
1831 capture response header Content-length len 9
1832 capture response header Location len 15
1833
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001834 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001835 about logging.
1836
1837
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001838clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001839 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1841 yes | yes | yes | no
1842 Arguments :
1843 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1844 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1845 as explained at the top of this document.
1846
1847 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1848 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1849 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1850 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1851 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1852 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1853 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1854 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001855 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001856 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1857 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1858
1859 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1860 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1861 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1862 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1863 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1864 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1865
1866 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1867 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1868
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001869 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1870 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001871
1872
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001873contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001874 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1876 yes | no | yes | yes
1877 Arguments :
1878 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1879 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1880 as explained at the top of this document.
1881
1882 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001883 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001884 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001885 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1886 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1887 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1888 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1889
1890 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1891 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1892 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1893 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1894 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1895 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1896
1897 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1898 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1899 instead.
1900
1901 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1902 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1903
1904
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001905cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001906 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
1907 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001908 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1910 yes | no | yes | yes
1911 Arguments :
1912 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1913 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1914 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1915 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1916 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1917 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1918 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1919 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1920 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1921
1922 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1923 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1924 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1925 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1926 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1927 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1928 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1929 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1930 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1931 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1932 "insert" and "prefix".
1933
1934 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001935 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001936
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001937 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001938 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1939 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1940 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1941 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1942 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1943 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1944 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1945 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1946 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1947 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001948
1949 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1950 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1951 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1952 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1953 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1954 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1955 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1956 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1957 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1958 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001959 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
1960 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
1961 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001962
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001963 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1964 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1965 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001966 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1967 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1968 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1969 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001970 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
1971 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
1972 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001973
1974 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1975 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1976 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1977 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1978 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1979 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1980 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1981 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1982 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1983
1984 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1985 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1986 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1987 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1988 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1989 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1990 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1991 persistence cookie in the cache.
1992 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1993
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001994 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1995 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1996 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1997 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1998 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1999 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2000 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2001 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2002 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2003 they logout.
2004
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002005 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2006 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2007 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2008 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2009
2010 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2011 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2012 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2013 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2014 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2015 this attribute.
2016
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002017 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002018 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002019 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2020 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2021 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2022 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2023 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2024 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002025
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002026 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2027 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2028 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2029 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2030 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2031 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2032 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2033 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2034 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2035 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2036 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2037 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2038 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2039 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2040 the site.
2041
2042 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2043 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2044 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2045 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2046 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2047 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2048 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2049 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2050 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2051 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2052 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2053 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2054 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2055 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2056 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2057 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2058
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002059 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2060 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2061 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2062 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002063
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002064 Examples :
2065 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2066 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2067 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002068 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002069
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002070 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002071 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002072
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002073
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002074default-server [param*]
2075 Change default options for a server in a backend
2076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2077 yes | no | yes | yes
2078 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002079 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2080 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2081 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2082 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002083
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002084 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002085 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2086
2087 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002088
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002089
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002090default_backend <backend>
2091 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2093 yes | yes | yes | no
2094 Arguments :
2095 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2096
2097 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2098 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2099 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2100 will catch all undetermined requests.
2101
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002102 Example :
2103
2104 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2105 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2106 default_backend dynamic
2107
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002108 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2109
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002110
2111disabled
2112 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2114 yes | yes | yes | yes
2115 Arguments : none
2116
2117 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2118 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2119 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2120 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2121 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2122 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2123 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2124
2125 See also : "enabled"
2126
2127
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002128dispatch <address>:<port>
2129 Set a default server address
2130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2131 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002132 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002133
2134 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2135 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2136 during start-up.
2137
2138 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2139 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2140 possible with normal servers.
2141
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002142 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002143 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2144 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2145 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2146 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2147
2148 See also : "server"
2149
2150
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002151enabled
2152 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2154 yes | yes | yes | yes
2155 Arguments : none
2156
2157 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2158 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2159
2160 See also : "disabled"
2161
2162
2163errorfile <code> <file>
2164 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2166 yes | yes | yes | yes
2167 Arguments :
2168 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002169 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002170
2171 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002172 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002173 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002174 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2175 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002176
2177 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2178 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2179 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2180
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002181 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2182
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002183 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2184 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2185 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2186 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2187
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002188 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2189 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2190 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2191 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2192 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2193 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2194
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002195 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2196 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2197 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002198 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002199 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2200
2201 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2202
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002203 Example :
2204 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2205 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2206 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2207
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002208
2209errorloc <code> <url>
2210errorloc302 <code> <url>
2211 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2213 yes | yes | yes | yes
2214 Arguments :
2215 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002216 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002217
2218 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2219 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2220 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2221 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2222 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2223
2224 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2225 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2226 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2227
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002228 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2229
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002230 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2231 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2232 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2233 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2234 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2235 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2236 request.
2237
2238 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2239
2240
2241errorloc303 <code> <url>
2242 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2244 yes | yes | yes | yes
2245 Arguments :
2246 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2247 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2248
2249 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2250 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2251 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2252 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2253 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2254
2255 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2256 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2257 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2258
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002259 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2260
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002261 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2262 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2263 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2264 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002265 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002266
2267 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2268
2269
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002270force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2271 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2272 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2273 no | yes | yes | yes
2274
2275 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2276 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2277 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2278 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2279 marked down for maintenance operations.
2280
2281 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2282 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2283 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2284 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2285 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2286 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2287 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2288 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2289 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2290
2291 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2292 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2293 is used.
2294
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002295 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002296 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002297
2298
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002299fullconn <conns>
2300 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2302 yes | no | yes | yes
2303 Arguments :
2304 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2305 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2306
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002307 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002308 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002309 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002310 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2311 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2312 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2313 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2314 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002315 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002316
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002317 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2318 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2319 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2320
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002321 Example :
2322 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2323 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2324 # connections.
2325 backend dynamic
2326 fullconn 10000
2327 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2328 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2329
2330 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2331
2332
2333grace <time>
2334 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002336 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002337 Arguments :
2338 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2339 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2340 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2341
2342 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2343 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002344 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002345 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2346
2347 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2348 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2349 simplify it.
2350
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002351
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002352hash-type <method>
2353 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2355 yes | no | yes | yes
2356 Arguments :
2357 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2358 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2359 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2360 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2361 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2362 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2363 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2364 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2365 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2366
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002367 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2368 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2369 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2370 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2371 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2372 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2373 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2374 this value.
2375
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002376 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2377 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2378 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2379 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2380 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2381 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2382 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2383 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2384 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2385 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2386 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2387 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2388 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2389
2390 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2391
2392 See also : "balance", "server"
2393
2394
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002395http-check disable-on-404
2396 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002398 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002399 Arguments : none
2400
2401 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2402 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2403 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2404 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2405 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2406 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2407 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2408 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002409 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2410 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2411 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2412
2413 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2414
2415
2416http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002417 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002419 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002420 Arguments :
2421 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2422 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002423 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002424 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2425 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2426 details on the supported keywords.
2427
2428 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2429 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2430 with the usual backslash ('\').
2431
2432 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2433 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2434 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2435 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2436 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2437
2438 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002439 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002440 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2441 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2442 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2443
2444 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002445 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002446 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2447 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2448 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2449 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2450
2451 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002452 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002453 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2454 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2455 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2456 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2457 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2458 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2459 trace).
2460
2461 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002462 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002463 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2464 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2465 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2466 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2467 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2468 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2469
2470 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2471 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2472 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2473 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2474 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2475 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2476 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2477 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2478
2479 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2480 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2481
2482 Examples :
2483 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002484 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002485
2486 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002487 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002488
2489 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002490 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002491
2492 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002493 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002494
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002495 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002496
2497
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002498http-check send-state
2499 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2501 yes | no | yes | yes
2502 Arguments : none
2503
2504 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2505 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2506 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2507 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2508 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2509
2510 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2511 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2512 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2513 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2514 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2515 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2516 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2517 checked in multiple backends.
2518
2519 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2520 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2521
2522 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2523 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2524 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2525 one fails.
2526
2527 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2528 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2529 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2530
2531 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2532 server's queue.
2533
2534 Example of a header received by the application server :
2535 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2536 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2537
2538 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2539
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002540http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002541 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002542 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2543
2544 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2545 no | yes | yes | yes
2546
2547 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2548 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2549 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002550 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2551 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002552 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2553
2554 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2555 instance.
2556
2557 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002558 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2559 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2560 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002561
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002562 http-request allow if nagios
2563 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2564 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2565 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002566
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002567 Example:
2568 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002569
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002570 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002571
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002572 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2573 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002574
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002575http-send-name-header [<header>]
2576 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2577
2578 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2579 yes | no | yes | yes
2580
2581 Arguments :
2582
2583 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2584
2585 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2586 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2587 is added with the header string proved.
2588
2589 See also : "server"
2590
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002591id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002592 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2594 no | yes | yes | yes
2595 Arguments : none
2596
2597 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2598 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2599 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002600
2601
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002602ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2603 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2604 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2605 no | yes | yes | yes
2606
2607 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2608 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2609 and running).
2610
2611 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2612 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2613 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2614 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2615 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2616
2617 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2618 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2619
2620 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2621 "unless" condition is met.
2622
2623 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2624
2625
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002626log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002627log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002628no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002629 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2631 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002632
2633 Prefix :
2634 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2635 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2636 prefix does not allow arguments.
2637
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002638 Arguments :
2639 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2640 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2641 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2642 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2643 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2644 parameter.
2645
2646 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2647 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2648
2649 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2650 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2651 standard syslog port).
2652
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002653 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2654 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2655 standard syslog port).
2656
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002657 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2658 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2659 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2660 appropriately writeable).
2661
2662 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2663
2664 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2665 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2666 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2667
2668 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2669 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2670 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002671 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2672 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2673 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2674 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2675 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002676
2677 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2678
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002679 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2680 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2681 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002682
2683 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2684 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2685 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2686 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2687
2688 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2689 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002690
2691 Example :
2692 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002693 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2694 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002695
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002696log-format <string>
2697 Allows you to custom a log line.
2698
2699 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2700
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002701
2702maxconn <conns>
2703 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2705 yes | yes | yes | no
2706 Arguments :
2707 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2708 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2709 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2710 closes.
2711
2712 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2713 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2714 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2715 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2716 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2717 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2718 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2719 properly tuned.
2720
2721 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2722 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2723 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2724
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02002725 By default, this value is set to 2000.
2726
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002727 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2728
2729
2730mode { tcp|http|health }
2731 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2733 yes | yes | yes | yes
2734 Arguments :
2735 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2736 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2737 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2738 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2739
2740 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2741 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2742 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2743 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2744 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2745
2746 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2747 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2748 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2749 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2750 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2751 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2752
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002753 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2754 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2755 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002756
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002757 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002758 defaults http_instances
2759 mode http
2760
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002761 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002762
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002763
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002764monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002765 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2767 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002768 Arguments :
2769 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2770 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002771 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002772 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2773 backend and its backup.
2774
2775 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2776 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2777 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2778 servers in a list of backends.
2779
2780 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2781 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2782 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2783 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2784 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2785 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2786 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002787 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2788 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002789
2790 Example:
2791 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002792 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002793 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2794 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2795 monitor-uri /site_alive
2796 monitor fail if site_dead
2797
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002798 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002799
2800
2801monitor-net <source>
2802 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2804 yes | yes | yes | no
2805 Arguments :
2806 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2807 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2808 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2809 followed by a mask.
2810
2811 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2812 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002813 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002814 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2815
2816 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2817 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2818 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2819 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2820 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2821
2822 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2823 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2824 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2825 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2826 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2827
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002828 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2829 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002830
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002831 Example :
2832 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2833 frontend www
2834 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2835
2836 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2837
2838
2839monitor-uri <uri>
2840 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2842 yes | yes | yes | no
2843 Arguments :
2844 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2845 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2846
2847 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2848 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2849 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2850 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2851 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2852 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2853 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2854 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2855
2856 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2857 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2858 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2859 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2860 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2861 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2862
2863 Example :
2864 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2865 frontend www
2866 mode http
2867 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2868
2869 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2870
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002871
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002872option abortonclose
2873no option abortonclose
2874 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2876 yes | no | yes | yes
2877 Arguments : none
2878
2879 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2880 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2881 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2882 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002883 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002884 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2885 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2886 encountered while delivering the response.
2887
2888 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2889 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2890 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2891 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2892 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2893 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002894 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002895 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002896 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002897 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2898 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2899 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2900
2901 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2902 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2903 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2904 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2905 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2906 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2907 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2908 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002909 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002910
2911 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2912 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2913
2914 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2915
2916
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002917option accept-invalid-http-request
2918no option accept-invalid-http-request
2919 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2921 yes | yes | yes | no
2922 Arguments : none
2923
2924 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2925 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2926 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2927 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2928 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2929 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2930 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2931 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002932 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
2933 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
2934 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
2935 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
2936 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
2937 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002938
2939 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2940 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2941 been confirmed.
2942
2943 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2944 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002945 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
2946 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002947 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2948
2949 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2950 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2951
2952 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2953 stats socket.
2954
2955
2956option accept-invalid-http-response
2957no option accept-invalid-http-response
2958 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2960 yes | no | yes | yes
2961 Arguments : none
2962
2963 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2964 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2965 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2966 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2967 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2968 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2969 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2970 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2971 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2972
2973 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2974 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2975 been confirmed.
2976
2977 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2978 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2979 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2980 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2981
2982 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2983 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2984
2985 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2986 stats socket.
2987
2988
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002989option allbackups
2990no option allbackups
2991 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2993 yes | no | yes | yes
2994 Arguments : none
2995
2996 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2997 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2998 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2999 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3000 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3001 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3002 order between the backup servers anymore.
3003
3004 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3005 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3006
3007 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3008 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3009
3010
3011option checkcache
3012no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003013 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3015 yes | no | yes | yes
3016 Arguments : none
3017
3018 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3019 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003020 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003021 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3022 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003023 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003024
3025 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003026 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003027 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003028 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3029 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003030 to the client are :
3031 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003032 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003033 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003034 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3035 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3036 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3037 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3038 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3039 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3040 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3041 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3042 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3043 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3044 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3045
3046 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003047 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003048 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003049 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003050 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3051
3052 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3053 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003054 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003055 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3056
3057 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3058 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3059
3060
3061option clitcpka
3062no option clitcpka
3063 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3065 yes | yes | yes | no
3066 Arguments : none
3067
3068 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3069 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3070 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3071 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3072
3073 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3074 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3075 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3076 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3077
3078 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3079 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3080 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3081 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3082 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3083
3084 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3085
3086 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3087 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3088 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3089
3090 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3091 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3092
3093 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3094
3095
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003096option contstats
3097 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3099 yes | yes | yes | no
3100 Arguments : none
3101
3102 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3103 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3104 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3105 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3106 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3107 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3108 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3109
3110
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003111option dontlog-normal
3112no option dontlog-normal
3113 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3115 yes | yes | yes | no
3116 Arguments : none
3117
3118 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3119 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3120 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3121 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3122 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3123 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3124 logged.
3125
3126 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3127 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3128 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003130 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003131 logging.
3132
3133
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003134option dontlognull
3135no option dontlognull
3136 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3138 yes | yes | yes | no
3139 Arguments : none
3140
3141 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3142 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3143 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3144 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3145 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3146 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3147 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3148
3149 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3150 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3151 would not be logged.
3152
3153 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3154 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3155
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003156 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003157
3158
3159option forceclose
3160no option forceclose
3161 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003163 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003164 Arguments : none
3165
3166 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3167 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3168 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3169 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3170 global session times in the logs.
3171
3172 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003173 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003174 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3175 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3176 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3177 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003178
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003179 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3180 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3181 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3182
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003183 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3184 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3185
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003186 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003187
3188
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003189option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003190 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3192 yes | yes | yes | yes
3193 Arguments :
3194 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3195 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003196 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003197 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003198
3199 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3200 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3201 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3202 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3203 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3204 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3205 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003206 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3207 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3208 possible that the client has already brought one.
3209
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003210 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003211 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003212 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3213 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003214 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3215 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003216
3217 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3218 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3219 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3220 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3221 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3222 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3223 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3224
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003225 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3226 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3227 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3228 are under the control of the end-user.
3229
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003230 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003231 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3232 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003233 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3234 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3235 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003236
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003237 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3238 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3239 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3240 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3241 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003242
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003243 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003244 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3245 frontend www
3246 mode http
3247 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3248
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003249 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3250 backend www
3251 mode http
3252 option forwardfor header X-Client
3253
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003254 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3255 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003256
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003257
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003258option http-no-delay
3259no option http-no-delay
3260 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3262 yes | yes | yes | yes
3263 Arguments : none
3264
3265 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3266 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3267 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3268 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3269 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3270 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3271 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3272 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3273 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3274 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3275 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3276 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3277 affected.
3278
3279 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3280 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3281 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3282 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3283 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3284 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3285 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3286 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3287 latency environments.
3288
3289
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003290option http-pretend-keepalive
3291no option http-pretend-keepalive
3292 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3294 yes | yes | yes | yes
3295 Arguments : none
3296
3297 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3298 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3299 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3300 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3301 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3302 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3303 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3304 consider the response complete.
3305
3306 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3307 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3308 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3309 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3310 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3311 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3312
3313 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3314 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3315 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3316 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3317 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3318 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3319 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3320
3321 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3322 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003323 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003324 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3325 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003326
3327 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3328 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3329
3330 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3331
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003332
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003333option http-server-close
3334no option http-server-close
3335 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3337 yes | yes | yes | yes
3338 Arguments : none
3339
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003340 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3341 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3342 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3343 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3344 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3345 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3346 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3347 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3348 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3349 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3350 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3351 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003352
3353 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3354 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3355 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3356 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003357 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3358 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003359
3360 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3361 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003362 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3363 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3364 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003365
3366 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3367 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3368
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003369 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3370 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003371
3372
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003373option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003374no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003375 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3377 yes | yes | yes | no
3378 Arguments : none
3379
3380 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3381 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3382 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3383 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3384 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3385 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3386 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3387
3388 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3389 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3390 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3391 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3392 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3393 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3394 request along its whole life.
3395
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003396 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3397 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3398 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3399 front of an existing proxy.
3400
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003401 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3402
3403 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3404 http-server-close".
3405
3406
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003407option httpchk
3408option httpchk <uri>
3409option httpchk <method> <uri>
3410option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3411 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3413 yes | no | yes | yes
3414 Arguments :
3415 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3416 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3417 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3418 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3419 ones.
3420
3421 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3422 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3423 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3424
3425 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3426 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3427 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3428 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3429 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3430
3431 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3432 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3433 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3434 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3435 the lack of any response.
3436
3437 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3438
3439 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3440 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3441 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3442
3443 Examples :
3444 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3445 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3446 backend https_relay
3447 mode tcp
3448 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3449 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3450
3451 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003452 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3453 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003454
3455
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003456option httpclose
3457no option httpclose
3458 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3460 yes | yes | yes | yes
3461 Arguments : none
3462
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003463 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3464 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3465 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3466 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3467 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3468 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3469 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003470
3471 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003472 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003473 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3474 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3475 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3476 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3477 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003478
3479 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3480 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3481 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003482 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3483 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003484
3485 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3486 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3487
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003488 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3489 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003490
3491
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003492option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003493 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3495 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003496 Arguments :
3497 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3498 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3499 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3500 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3501 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003502
3503 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3504 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3505 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3506 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3507 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3508 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3509 ports.
3510
3511 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3512
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003513 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3514 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3515 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3516 by default.
3517
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003518 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003519
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003520
3521option http_proxy
3522no option http_proxy
3523 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3525 yes | yes | yes | yes
3526 Arguments : none
3527
3528 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3529 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3530 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3531 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3532 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3533
3534 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3535 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3536 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3537 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003538 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003539 be analyzed.
3540
3541 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3542 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3543
3544 Example :
3545 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3546 backend direct_forward
3547 option httpclose
3548 option http_proxy
3549
3550 See also : "option httpclose"
3551
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003552
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003553option independent-streams
3554no option independent-streams
3555 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3557 yes | yes | yes | yes
3558 Arguments : none
3559
3560 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3561 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3562 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3563 receive data or not.
3564
3565 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3566 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3567 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3568 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3569 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3570 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3571 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3572 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3573 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3574 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3575 socket buffers.
3576
3577 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3578 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3579 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3580 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3581 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3582
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003583 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3584 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3585 deprecated.
3586
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003587 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003588
3589
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003590option ldap-check
3591 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3593 yes | no | yes | yes
3594 Arguments : none
3595
3596 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3597 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3598 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3599 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3600
3601 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3602 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3603
3604 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3605 configure it.
3606
3607 Example :
3608 option ldap-check
3609
3610 See also : "option httpchk"
3611
3612
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003613option log-health-checks
3614no option log-health-checks
3615 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3617 yes | no | yes | yes
3618 Arguments : none
3619
3620 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3621 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3622 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3623 of additional information is limited.
3624
3625 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3626 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3627
3628 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3629
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003630
3631option log-separate-errors
3632no option log-separate-errors
3633 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3635 yes | yes | yes | no
3636 Arguments : none
3637
3638 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3639 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3640 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3641 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3642 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3643 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3644 provides very important information.
3645
3646 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3647 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3648 error logs.
3649
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003650 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003651 logging.
3652
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003653
3654option logasap
3655no option logasap
3656 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3658 yes | yes | yes | no
3659 Arguments : none
3660
3661 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3662 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3663 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3664 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3665 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3666 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3667 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003668 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003669 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3670 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3671
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003672 Examples :
3673 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3674 mode http
3675 option httplog
3676 option logasap
3677 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3678
3679 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3680 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3681 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3682 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3683
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003684 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003685 logging.
3686
3687
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003688option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3689 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3691 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003692 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003693 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
3694 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003695
3696 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3697 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3698 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3699 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3700 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3701 in the MySQL table, like this :
3702
3703 USE mysql;
3704 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3705 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3706
3707 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3708 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3709 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3710 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3711 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3712 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3713 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3714 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3715 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3716
3717 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3718 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003719
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003720 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003721
3722 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3723 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3724 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3725 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3726 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3727 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3728
3729 See also: "option httpchk"
3730
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003731option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3732 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3734 yes | no | yes | yes
3735 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003736 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
3737 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003738
3739 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3740 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3741 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3742 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3743
3744 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003745
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003746option nolinger
3747no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003748 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003749 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3750 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003751 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003752
3753 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3754 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3755 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3756 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3757 connections.
3758
3759 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3760 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3761 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3762 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3763 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3764 this too.
3765
3766 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3767 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3768 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3769
3770 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3771 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3772 for servers.
3773
3774 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3775 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3776
3777
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003778option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3779 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3781 yes | yes | yes | yes
3782 Arguments :
3783 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3784 matching <network>
3785 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3786 header name.
3787
3788 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3789 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3790 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3791 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3792 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3793 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3794 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3795 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3796 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3797 possible that the client has already brought one.
3798
3799 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3800 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3801 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3802 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3803 header and requires different one.
3804
3805 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3806 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3807 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3808 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3809 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3810 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3811 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3812
3813 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3814 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3815 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3816 both are defined.
3817
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003818 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3819 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3820 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3821 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3822 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003823
3824 Examples :
3825 # Original Destination address
3826 frontend www
3827 mode http
3828 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3829
3830 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3831 backend www
3832 mode http
3833 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3834
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003835 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3836 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003837
3838
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003839option persist
3840no option persist
3841 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3842 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3843 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003844 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003845
3846 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3847 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3848 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3849 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3850 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3851 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3852 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3853 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3854 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3855 redirected to another valid server.
3856
3857 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3858 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3859
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003860 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003861
3862
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003863option redispatch
3864no option redispatch
3865 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3866 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3867 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003868 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003869
3870 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3871 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3872 be able to access the service anymore.
3873
3874 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3875 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3876
3877 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3878 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3879 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003880
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003881 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3882 "redisp" keywords.
3883
3884 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3885 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3886
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003887 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003888
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003889
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003890option redis-check
3891 Use redis health checks for server testing
3892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3893 yes | no | yes | yes
3894 Arguments : none
3895
3896 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
3897 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
3898 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
3899 find the "+PONG" response message.
3900
3901 Example :
3902 option redis-check
3903
3904 See also : "option httpchk"
3905
3906
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003907option smtpchk
3908option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3909 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3911 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003912 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003913 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3914 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3915 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3916
3917 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3918 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3919 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3920
3921 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3922 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3923 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3924 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3925 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3926 dead server.
3927
3928 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3929 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3930 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3931 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3932
3933 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3934 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3935 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3936 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3937 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3938
3939 Example :
3940 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3941
3942 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3943
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003944
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003945option socket-stats
3946no option socket-stats
3947
3948 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3950 yes | yes | yes | no
3951
3952 Arguments : none
3953
3954
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003955option splice-auto
3956no option splice-auto
3957 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3959 yes | yes | yes | yes
3960 Arguments : none
3961
3962 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3963 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3964 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3965 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003966 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003967 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3968 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3969 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3970 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3971
3972 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3973 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3974 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3975 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3976 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3977 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3978 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3979 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3980 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3981 keyword.
3982
3983 Example :
3984 option splice-auto
3985
3986 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3987 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3988
3989 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3990 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3991
3992
3993option splice-request
3994no option splice-request
3995 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3997 yes | yes | yes | yes
3998 Arguments : none
3999
4000 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004001 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004002 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4003 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4004 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4005 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4006
4007 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4008
4009 Example :
4010 option splice-request
4011
4012 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4013 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4014
4015 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4016 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4017
4018
4019option splice-response
4020no option splice-response
4021 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4023 yes | yes | yes | yes
4024 Arguments : none
4025
4026 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004027 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004028 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4029 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4030 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4031 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4032
4033 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4034
4035 Example :
4036 option splice-response
4037
4038 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4039 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4040
4041 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4042 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4043
4044
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004045option srvtcpka
4046no option srvtcpka
4047 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4049 yes | no | yes | yes
4050 Arguments : none
4051
4052 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4053 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4054 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4055 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4056
4057 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4058 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4059 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4060 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4061
4062 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4063 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4064 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4065 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4066 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4067
4068 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4069
4070 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4071 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4072 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4073
4074 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4075 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4076
4077 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4078
4079
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004080option ssl-hello-chk
4081 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4082 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4083 yes | no | yes | yes
4084 Arguments : none
4085
4086 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4087 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4088 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4089 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4090 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4091 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4092 hello message.
4093
4094 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4095 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4096 messages, which is appreciable.
4097
4098 See also: "option httpchk"
4099
4100
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004101option tcp-smart-accept
4102no option tcp-smart-accept
4103 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4105 yes | yes | yes | no
4106 Arguments : none
4107
4108 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4109 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4110 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4111 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4112 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4113 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4114
4115 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4116 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4117 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4118 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4119
4120 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4121 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4122 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4123 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4124
4125 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4126 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4127 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4128
4129 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4130 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4131 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4132
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004133 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4134
4135
4136option tcp-smart-connect
4137no option tcp-smart-connect
4138 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4140 yes | no | yes | yes
4141 Arguments : none
4142
4143 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4144 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4145 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4146 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4147 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4148
4149 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4150 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4151 complex.
4152
4153 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4154 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4155 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4156
4157 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4158 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4159
4160 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4161
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004162
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004163option tcpka
4164 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4166 yes | yes | yes | yes
4167 Arguments : none
4168
4169 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4170 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4171 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4172 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4173
4174 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4175 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4176 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4177 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4178
4179 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4180 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4181 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4182 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4183 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4184
4185 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4186
4187 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4188 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4189 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4190 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4191 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4192 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4193 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4194 backends.
4195
4196 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4197
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004198
4199option tcplog
4200 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4202 yes | yes | yes | yes
4203 Arguments : none
4204
4205 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4206 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4207 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4208 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4209 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4210 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4211 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4212 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4213
4214 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4215
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004216 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004217
4218
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004219option transparent
4220no option transparent
4221 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004223 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004224 Arguments : none
4225
4226 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4227 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4228 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4229 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4230 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4231 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4232 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4233 appropriate server.
4234
4235 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4236 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4237
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004238 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004239 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004240
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004241
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004242persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004243persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004244 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4246 yes | no | yes | yes
4247 Arguments :
4248 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004249 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4250 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004251
4252 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4253 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4254 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4255 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4256 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4257 forwarded to this server.
4258
4259 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4260 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4261 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004262 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004263 a single "listen" section.
4264
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004265 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4266 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4267 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4268
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004269 Example :
4270 listen tse-farm
4271 bind :3389
4272 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4273 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4274 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4275 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4276 persist rdp-cookie
4277 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004278 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004279 balance rdp-cookie
4280 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4281 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4282
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004283 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4284 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004285
4286
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004287rate-limit sessions <rate>
4288 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4290 yes | yes | yes | no
4291 Arguments :
4292 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4293 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4294
4295 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4296 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4297 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4298 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4299 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4300 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4301
4302 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4303 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4304 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4305 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4306
4307 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4308 listen smtp
4309 mode tcp
4310 bind :25
4311 rate-limit sessions 10
4312 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4313
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004314 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4315 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4316 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004317
4318 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4319
4320
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004321redirect location <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4322redirect prefix <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004323 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4325 no | yes | yes | yes
4326
4327 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004328 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004329
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004330 Arguments :
4331 <to> With "redirect location", the exact value in <to> is placed into
4332 the HTTP "Location" header. In case of "redirect prefix", the
4333 "Location" header is built from the concatenation of <to> and the
4334 complete URI, including the query string, unless the "drop-query"
Willy Tarreaufe651a52008-11-19 21:15:17 +01004335 option is specified (see below). As a special case, if <to>
4336 equals exactly "/" in prefix mode, then nothing is inserted
4337 before the original URI. It allows one to redirect to the same
4338 URL.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004339
4340 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4341 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4342 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4343 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4344 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4345 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4346 location with a GET method.
4347
4348 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4349 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4350
4351 - "drop-query"
4352 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4353 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4354 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4355 with a location-type redirect.
4356
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004357 - "append-slash"
4358 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4359 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4360 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4361 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4362
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004363 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4364 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4365 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4366 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4367 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4368 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4369 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4370
4371 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4372 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4373 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4374 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4375 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4376 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4377 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004378
4379 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4380 acl clear dst_port 80
4381 acl secure dst_port 8080
4382 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004383 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004384 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004385 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4386
4387 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004388 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4389 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4390 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004391 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004392
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004393 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4394 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4395 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4396
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004397 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004398
4399
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004400redisp (deprecated)
4401redispatch (deprecated)
4402 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4403 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4404 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004405 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004406
4407 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4408 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4409 be able to access the service anymore.
4410
4411 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4412 redistribute them to a working server.
4413
4414 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4415 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4416 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004417
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004418 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4419 "option redispatch" instead.
4420
4421 See also : "option redispatch"
4422
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004423
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004424reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004425 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4427 no | yes | yes | yes
4428 Arguments :
4429 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4430 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004431 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004432
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004433 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4434 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4435
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004436 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4437 the last header of an HTTP request.
4438
4439 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4440 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4441 responses.
4442
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004443 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4444 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4445 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4446
4447 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4448 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004449
4450
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004451reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4452reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004453 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4455 no | yes | yes | yes
4456 Arguments :
4457 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4458 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4459 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4460 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4461 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4462 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4463 ignores case.
4464
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004465 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4466 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4467
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004468 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4469 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4470 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4471 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004472 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004473
4474 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4475 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4476
4477 Example :
4478 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4479 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4480 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4481
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004482 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4483 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004484
4485
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004486reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4487reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004488 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4490 no | yes | yes | yes
4491 Arguments :
4492 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4493 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4494 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4495 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4496 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4497 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4498
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004499 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4500 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4501
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004502 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4503 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4504 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4505 next servers.
4506
4507 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4508 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4509 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4510
4511 Example :
4512 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4513 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4514 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4515
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004516 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4517 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004518
4519
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004520reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4521reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004522 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4524 no | yes | yes | yes
4525 Arguments :
4526 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4527 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4528 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4529 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4530 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4531 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4532 case.
4533
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004534 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4535 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4536
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004537 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4538 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4539 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4540 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004541 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004542
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004543 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004544 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004545 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004546
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004547 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4548 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4549
4550 Example :
4551 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4552 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4553 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4554
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004555 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4556 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004557
4558
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004559reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4560reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004561 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4563 no | yes | yes | yes
4564 Arguments :
4565 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4566 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4567 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4568 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4569 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4570 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4571 case.
4572
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004573 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4574 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4575
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004576 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4577 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4578 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4579 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4580
4581 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4582 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4583
4584 Example :
4585 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4586 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4587 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4588 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4589
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004590 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4591 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004592
4593
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004594reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4595reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004596 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4598 no | yes | yes | yes
4599 Arguments :
4600 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4601 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4602 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4603 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4604 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4605 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4606
4607 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4608 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4609 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4610 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004611 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004612
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004613 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4614 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4615
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004616 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4617 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4618 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4619
4620 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4621 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4622 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4623 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4624 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4625
4626 Example :
4627 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04004628 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004629 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4630 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4631
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004632 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4633 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004634
4635
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004636reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4637reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004638 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4640 no | yes | yes | yes
4641 Arguments :
4642 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4643 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4644 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4645 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4646 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4647 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4648 ignores case.
4649
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004650 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4651 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4652
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004653 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4654 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004655 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4656 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4657 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004658 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4659 not set.
4660
4661 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4662 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4663 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4664 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4665 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4666
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004667 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004668 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4669 # block all others.
4670 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4671 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4672
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004673 # block bad guys
4674 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4675 reqitarpit . if badguys
4676
4677 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4678 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004679
4680
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004681retries <value>
4682 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4683 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4684 yes | no | yes | yes
4685 Arguments :
4686 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4687 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4688 default value is 3.
4689
4690 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4691 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4692 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4693
4694 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4695 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4696
4697 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4698 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4699
4700 See also : "option redispatch"
4701
4702
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004703rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004704 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4706 no | yes | yes | yes
4707 Arguments :
4708 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4709 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004710 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004711
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004712 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4713 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4714
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004715 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4716 the last header of an HTTP response.
4717
4718 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4719 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4720 responses.
4721
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004722 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4723 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004724
4725
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004726rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4727rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004728 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4730 no | yes | yes | yes
4731 Arguments :
4732 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4733 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4734 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4735 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4736 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4737 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4738 ignores case.
4739
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004740 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4741 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4742
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004743 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4744 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004745 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004746 client.
4747
4748 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4749 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4750 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4751
4752 Example :
4753 # remove the Server header from responses
4754 reqidel ^Server:.*
4755
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004756 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4757 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004758
4759
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004760rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4761rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004762 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4764 no | yes | yes | yes
4765 Arguments :
4766 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4767 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4768 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4769 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4770 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4771 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4772 ignores case.
4773
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004774 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4775 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4776
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004777 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4778 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4779 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4780 case-sensitive.
4781
4782 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004783 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4784 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4785 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004786
4787 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4788 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4789
4790 Example :
4791 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4792 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4793
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004794 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4795 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004796
4797
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004798rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4799rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004800 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4802 no | yes | yes | yes
4803 Arguments :
4804 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4805 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4806 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4807 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4808 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4809 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4810 ignores case.
4811
4812 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4813 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4814 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4815 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004816 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004817
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004818 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4819 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4820
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004821 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4822 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4823 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4824
4825 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4826 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4827 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4828 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4829 are not case-sensitive.
4830
4831 Example :
4832 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4833 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4834
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004835 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4836 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004837
4838
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004839server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004840 Declare a server in a backend
4841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4842 no | no | yes | yes
4843 Arguments :
4844 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004845 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-server-name" is
4846 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004847
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004848 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4849 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4850 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4851 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004852 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4853 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4854 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4855 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4856 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4857 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004858
4859 <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
4860 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4861 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4862 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4863 adding this value to the client's port.
4864
4865 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4866 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004867 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004868
4869 Examples :
4870 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4871 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4872
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004873 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
4874 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004875
4876
4877source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004878source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004879source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004880 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4882 yes | no | yes | yes
4883 Arguments :
4884 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4885 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4886 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4887 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4888
4889 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4890 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004891 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4892 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4893 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004894
4895 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4896 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4897 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4898 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4899 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4900 <addr>.
4901
4902 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4903 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4904 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4905 port.
4906
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004907 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4908 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4909 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4910 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4911 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4912 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4913 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4914 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4915 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4916 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4917 HTTP header.
4918
4919 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4920 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004921 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004922 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4923 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4924 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4925 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4926 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4927 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4928 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4929
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004930 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4931 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4932 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4933 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4934 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4935 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4936
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004937 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4938 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4939 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4940 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4941
4942 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4943 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4944 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4945 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4946 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4947 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4948
4949 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4950 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4951 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4952 there are two methods :
4953
4954 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4955 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4956 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4957 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4958 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4959 of the client ranges may be used.
4960
4961 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4962 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4963 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4964 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4965 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4966 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4967 same session.
4968
4969 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4970 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4971 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4972 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4973 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4974 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4975
4976 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4977 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4978 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004979 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004980
4981 Examples :
4982 backend private
4983 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4984 source 192.168.1.200
4985
4986 backend transparent_ssl1
4987 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4988 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4989
4990 backend transparent_ssl2
4991 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4992 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4993 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4994
4995 backend transparent_ssl3
4996 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4997 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4998 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4999
5000 backend transparent_smtp
5001 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5002 # with Tproxy version 4.
5003 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5004
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005005 backend transparent_http
5006 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5007 # proxy.
5008 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5009
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005010 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005011 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5012
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005013
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005014srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5015 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5017 yes | no | yes | yes
5018 Arguments :
5019 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5020 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5021 as explained at the top of this document.
5022
5023 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5024 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5025 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5026 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5027 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5028 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5029 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5030
5031 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5032 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5033 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5034 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5035 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005036 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005037 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005038 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005039
5040 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5041 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5042 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5043 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5044 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5045 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5046
5047 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5048 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5049
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005050 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5051 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005052
5053
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005054stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5055 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5057 no | no | yes | yes
5058
5059 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5060 matched.
5061
5062 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5063 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5064
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005065 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5066 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5067 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5068
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005069 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5070 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5071 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5072 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005073
5074 Example :
5075 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5076 backend stats_localhost
5077 stats enable
5078 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5079
5080 Example :
5081 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5082 backend stats_auth
5083 stats enable
5084 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5085 stats admin if TRUE
5086
5087 Example :
5088 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5089 userlist stats-auth
5090 group admin users admin
5091 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5092 group readonly users haproxy
5093 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5094
5095 backend stats_auth
5096 stats enable
5097 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5098 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5099 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5100 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5101
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005102 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5103 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5104 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005105
5106
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005107stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5108 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5110 yes | no | yes | yes
5111 Arguments :
5112 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5113
5114 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5115
5116 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5117 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5118 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5119 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5120 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5121 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5122
5123 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5124 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5125 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005126 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005127
5128 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5129 report using "stats scope".
5130
5131 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5132 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5133 unobvious parameters.
5134
5135 Example :
5136 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5137 backend public_www
5138 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5139 stats enable
5140 stats hide-version
5141 stats scope .
5142 stats uri /admin?stats
5143 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5144 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5145 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5146
5147 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5148 backend private_monitoring
5149 stats enable
5150 stats uri /admin?stats
5151 stats refresh 5s
5152
5153 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5154
5155
5156stats enable
5157 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5159 yes | no | yes | yes
5160 Arguments : none
5161
5162 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5163 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5164 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5165 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5166 - stats auth : no authentication
5167 - stats scope : no restriction
5168
5169 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5170 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5171 unobvious parameters.
5172
5173 Example :
5174 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5175 backend public_www
5176 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5177 stats enable
5178 stats hide-version
5179 stats scope .
5180 stats uri /admin?stats
5181 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5182 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5183 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5184
5185 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5186 backend private_monitoring
5187 stats enable
5188 stats uri /admin?stats
5189 stats refresh 5s
5190
5191 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5192
5193
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005194stats hide-version
5195 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5197 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005198 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005199
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005200 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5201 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5202 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5203 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5204 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5205 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005206
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005207 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5208 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5209 unobvious parameters.
5210
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005211 Example :
5212 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5213 backend public_www
5214 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005215 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005216 stats hide-version
5217 stats scope .
5218 stats uri /admin?stats
5219 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5220 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5221 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005222
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005223 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5224 backend private_monitoring
5225 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005226 stats uri /admin?stats
5227 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005228
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005229 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005230
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005231
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005232stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5233 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5234 Access control for statistics
5235
5236 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5237 no | no | yes | yes
5238
5239 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5240 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5241 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5242 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5243 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5244 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5245
5246 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5247 instance.
5248
5249 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5250 about ACL usage.
5251
5252
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005253stats realm <realm>
5254 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5256 yes | no | yes | yes
5257 Arguments :
5258 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5259 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5260 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5261
5262 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5263 using a backslash ('\').
5264
5265 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5266 only related to authentication.
5267
5268 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5269 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5270 unobvious parameters.
5271
5272 Example :
5273 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5274 backend public_www
5275 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5276 stats enable
5277 stats hide-version
5278 stats scope .
5279 stats uri /admin?stats
5280 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5281 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5282 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5283
5284 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5285 backend private_monitoring
5286 stats enable
5287 stats uri /admin?stats
5288 stats refresh 5s
5289
5290 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5291
5292
5293stats refresh <delay>
5294 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5296 yes | no | yes | yes
5297 Arguments :
5298 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5299 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5300 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5301 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5302 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5303 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5304
5305 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5306 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5307 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5308 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5309
5310 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5311 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5312 unobvious parameters.
5313
5314 Example :
5315 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5316 backend public_www
5317 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5318 stats enable
5319 stats hide-version
5320 stats scope .
5321 stats uri /admin?stats
5322 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5323 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5324 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5325
5326 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5327 backend private_monitoring
5328 stats enable
5329 stats uri /admin?stats
5330 stats refresh 5s
5331
5332 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5333
5334
5335stats scope { <name> | "." }
5336 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5338 yes | no | yes | yes
5339 Arguments :
5340 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5341 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5342 section in which the statement appears.
5343
5344 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5345 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5346 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5347 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5348 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5349 exists.
5350
5351 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5352 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5353 unobvious parameters.
5354
5355 Example :
5356 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5357 backend public_www
5358 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5359 stats enable
5360 stats hide-version
5361 stats scope .
5362 stats uri /admin?stats
5363 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5364 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5365 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5366
5367 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5368 backend private_monitoring
5369 stats enable
5370 stats uri /admin?stats
5371 stats refresh 5s
5372
5373 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5374
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005375
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005376stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005377 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5379 yes | no | yes | yes
5380
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005381 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005382 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5383
5384 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5385 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5386
5387 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5388 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005389 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005390
5391 Example :
5392 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5393 backend private_monitoring
5394 stats enable
5395 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5396 stats uri /admin?stats
5397 stats refresh 5s
5398
5399 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5400 global section.
5401
5402
5403stats show-legends
5404 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5405 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5406 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5407 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5408 - IP (socket, server)
5409 - cookie (backend, server)
5410
5411 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5412 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005413 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005414
5415 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5416
5417
5418stats show-node [ <name> ]
5419 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5421 yes | no | yes | yes
5422 Arguments:
5423 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5424 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5425
5426 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5427 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005428 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005429
5430 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5431 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5432 unobvious parameters.
5433
5434 Example:
5435 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5436 backend private_monitoring
5437 stats enable
5438 stats show-node Europe-1
5439 stats uri /admin?stats
5440 stats refresh 5s
5441
5442 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5443 section.
5444
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005445
5446stats uri <prefix>
5447 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5449 yes | no | yes | yes
5450 Arguments :
5451 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5452 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5453 query string.
5454
5455 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5456 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5457 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5458 possible to reach it in the application.
5459
5460 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005461 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005462 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5463 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5464 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5465 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5466
5467 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5468 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5469 an address or a port to statistics only.
5470
5471 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5472 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5473 unobvious parameters.
5474
5475 Example :
5476 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5477 backend public_www
5478 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5479 stats enable
5480 stats hide-version
5481 stats scope .
5482 stats uri /admin?stats
5483 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5484 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5485 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5486
5487 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5488 backend private_monitoring
5489 stats enable
5490 stats uri /admin?stats
5491 stats refresh 5s
5492
5493 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5494
5495
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005496stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5497 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005499 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005500
5501 Arguments :
5502 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5503 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5504 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5505 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5506
5507 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5508 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5509 the "stick-table" statement.
5510
5511 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5512 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5513 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5514 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5515 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5516
5517 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5518 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5519 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5520 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5521 transformation rules.
5522
5523 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5524 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5525 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5526 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5527 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5528 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5529 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5530
5531 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5532 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5533 ACL based conditions.
5534
5535 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5536 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5537 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5538 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5539
5540 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5541 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5542 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5543 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5544
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005545 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5546 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5547 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5548
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005549 Example :
5550 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5551 # last 30 minutes
5552 backend pop
5553 mode tcp
5554 balance roundrobin
5555 stick store-request src
5556 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5557 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5558 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5559
5560 backend smtp
5561 mode tcp
5562 balance roundrobin
5563 stick match src table pop
5564 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5565 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5566
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005567 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5568 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005569
5570
5571stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5572 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5574 no | no | yes | yes
5575
5576 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5577 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5578 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5579 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5580
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005581 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5582 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5583 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5584
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005585 Examples :
5586 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005587 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005588
5589 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5590 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5591 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5592
5593
5594 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5595 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5596 backend http
5597 mode http
5598 balance roundrobin
5599 stick on src table https
5600 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5601 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5602 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5603
5604 backend https
5605 mode tcp
5606 balance roundrobin
5607 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5608 stick on src
5609 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5610 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5611
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005612 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005613
5614
5615stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5616 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5618 no | no | yes | yes
5619
5620 Arguments :
5621 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5622 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5623 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5624 server is selected.
5625
5626 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5627 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5628 the "stick-table" statement.
5629
5630 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5631 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5632 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5633 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5634 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5635 address.
5636
5637 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5638 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5639 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5640 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5641 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5642 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5643 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5644 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5645 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5646 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5647
5648 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5649 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5650 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5651 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5652 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5653 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5654 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5655
5656 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5657 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5658 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5659 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5660
5661 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5662 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5663 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5664 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5665 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5666 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5667 another protocol or access method.
5668
5669 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5670 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5671 the request.
5672
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005673 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5674 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5675 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5676
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005677 Example :
5678 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5679 # last 30 minutes
5680 backend pop
5681 mode tcp
5682 balance roundrobin
5683 stick store-request src
5684 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5685 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5686 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5687
5688 backend smtp
5689 mode tcp
5690 balance roundrobin
5691 stick match src table pop
5692 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5693 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5694
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005695 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5696 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005697
5698
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005699stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005700 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5701 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005702 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005704 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005705
5706 Arguments :
5707 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5708 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5709 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5710 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5711
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005712 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5713 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5714 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5715 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5716
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005717 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5718 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5719 instance.
5720
5721 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5722 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5723 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5724 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5725 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5726 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005727 to 32 characters.
5728
5729 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5730 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5731 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5732 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5733 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5734 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005735
5736 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005737 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5738 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005739 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5740 increase.
5741
5742 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005743 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5744 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5745 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005746
5747 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5748 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5749 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5750 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5751 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5752 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5753 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5754 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5755 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5756 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5757 parameter (see below).
5758
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005759 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5760 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5761 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5762 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5763 soft restart.
5764
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005765 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5766
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005767 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5768 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5769 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5770 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5771 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005772 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005773 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5774 if not expiration delay is specified.
5775
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005776 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5777 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5778 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5779 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005780 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5781 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5782 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5783 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5784 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5785 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5786 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5787 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5788 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5789 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5790 types and their arguments.
5791
5792 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5793 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5794 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5795 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5796
5797 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5798 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5799 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5800 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5801
5802 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5803 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5804 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5805 they were received.
5806
5807 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5808 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5809 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5810 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5811 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5812
5813 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5814 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5815 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5816 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5817 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5818
5819 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5820 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5821 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5822
5823 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5824 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5825 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5826 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5827 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5828
5829 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5830 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5831 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5832 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5833 the client side.
5834
5835 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5836 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5837 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5838 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5839 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5840 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5841 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5842
5843 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5844 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5845 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5846 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5847 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5848 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5849 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5850
5851 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5852 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5853 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5854 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5855 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5856 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5857
5858 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5859 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5860 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5861 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5862
5863 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5864 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5865 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5866 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5867 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5868 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5869 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5870 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5871 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5872 recommended for better fairness.
5873
5874 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5875 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5876 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5877 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5878
5879 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5880 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5881 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5882 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5883 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5884 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5885 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5886 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5887 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5888 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005889
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005890 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5891 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005892 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5893 reference it.
5894
5895 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5896 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5897 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5898 as an exclusive stickiness.
5899
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005900 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5901 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5902 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5903 something that can be ignored.
5904
5905 Example:
5906 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5907 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5908 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5909 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5910
5911 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005912 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005913
5914
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005915stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5916 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5918 no | no | yes | yes
5919
5920 Arguments :
5921 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5922 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5923 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5924 server is selected.
5925
5926 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5927 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5928 the "stick-table" statement.
5929
5930 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5931 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5932 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5933 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5934
5935 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5936 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5937 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5938 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5939 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5940 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005941 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005942 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5943 rules.
5944
5945 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5946 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5947 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5948 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5949 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5950 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5951 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5952
5953 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5954 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5955 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5956 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5957
5958 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5959 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5960 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5961 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5962 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5963 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5964 another protocol or access method.
5965
5966 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5967
5968 Example :
5969 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5970 backend https
5971 mode tcp
5972 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005973 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005974 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005975
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005976 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5977 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5978
5979 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5980 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5981 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5982
5983 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5984 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005985
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005986 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5987 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5988 # at offset 44.
5989
5990 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5991 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5992
5993 # Learn on response if server hello.
5994 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005995
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005996 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5997 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5998
5999 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6000 extraction.
6001
6002
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006003tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6004 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6006 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006007 Arguments :
6008 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6009 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6010 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006011
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006012 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006013
6014 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6015 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006016 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6017 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6018 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6019 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6020 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6021 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006022
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006023 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6024 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6025 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6026 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006027
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006028 Three types of actions are supported :
6029 - accept :
6030 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6031 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6032 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006033
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006034 - reject :
6035 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6036 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6037 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6038 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6039 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6040 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6041 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6042 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6043 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6044 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6045 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6046 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006047
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006048 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
6049 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6050 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6051 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
6052 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6053 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
6054 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
6055 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
6056 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006057
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006058 These actions take one or two arguments :
6059 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
6060 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
6061 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006062
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006063 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6064 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6065 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6066 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006067
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006068 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6069 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6070 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6071 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6072 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
6073 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6074 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6075 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6076 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6077 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006078
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006079 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6080 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6081 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006082
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006083 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6084 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6085 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006086
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006087 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006088 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006089 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006090
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006091 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6092 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6093 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006094
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006095 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6096 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6097 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006098
6099 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6100
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006101 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006102
6103
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006104tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6105 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006107 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006108 Arguments :
6109 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6110 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6111 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006112
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006113 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006114
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006115 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6116 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6117 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6118 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6119 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006120
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006121 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6122 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6123 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6124 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6125 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6126 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6127 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6128 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6129 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006130
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006131 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6132 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6133 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6134 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006135
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006136 Three types of actions are supported :
6137 - accept :
6138 - reject :
6139 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006140
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006141 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6142 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006143
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006144 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6145 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6146 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
6147 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
6148 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
6149 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006150
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006151 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006152 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6153 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006154
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006155 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006156 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6157 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6158 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6159 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6160 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006161
6162 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006163 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6164 # and reject everything else.
6165 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6166 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006167 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006168 tcp-request content reject
6169
6170 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006171 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6172 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6173 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006174 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006175
6176 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6177 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6178 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006179 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006180 tcp-request content reject
6181
6182 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6183 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6184
6185 frontend http
6186 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6187 # protecting all our sites
6188 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6189 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6190 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6191 ...
6192 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6193
6194 backend http_dynamic
6195 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6196 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6197 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6198 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6199 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6200 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6201 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006202
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006203 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006204
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006205 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006206
6207
6208tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6209 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006211 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006212 Arguments :
6213 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6214 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6215 as explained at the top of this document.
6216
6217 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6218 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6219 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6220 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6221 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6222
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006223 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6224 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6225 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6226 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6227
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006228 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6229 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006230 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006231 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006232 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6233 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6234 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6235 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006236
6237 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6238 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6239 it pass through unaffected.
6240
6241 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6242 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6243 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006244 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006245 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6246 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006247 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6248 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6249 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006250
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006251 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006252 "timeout client".
6253
6254
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006255tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6256 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6258 no | no | yes | yes
6259 Arguments :
6260 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6261 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6262 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6263
6264 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6265
6266 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6267 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6268 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6269 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006270 set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006271
6272 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6273
6274 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6275 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6276 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6277 inserted.
6278
6279 Two types of actions are supported :
6280 - accept :
6281 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6282 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6283 the rules evaluation.
6284
6285 - reject :
6286 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6287 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006288 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006289
6290 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6291 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6292 for changing the default action to a reject.
6293
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006294 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6295 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6296 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6297 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006298 period.
6299
6300 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6301
6302 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6303
6304
6305tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6306 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6308 no | no | yes | yes
6309 Arguments :
6310 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6311 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6312 as explained at the top of this document.
6313
6314 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6315
6316
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006317timeout check <timeout>
6318 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6319 established.
6320
6321 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6322 yes | no | yes | yes
6323 Arguments:
6324 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6325 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6326 as explained at the top of this document.
6327
6328 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6329 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6330 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6331 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006332 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6333 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6334 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006335
6336 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6337 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6338
6339 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6340 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006341 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006342
6343 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6344 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6345 forget about it.
6346
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006347 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6348 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006349
6350
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006351timeout client <timeout>
6352timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6353 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6355 yes | yes | yes | no
6356 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006357 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006358 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6359 as explained at the top of this document.
6360
6361 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6362 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6363 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6364 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6365 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6366 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6367 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6368 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006369 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006370 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006371 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6372 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6373 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006374
6375 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6376 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6377 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6378 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6379 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6380 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6381
6382 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6383 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6384 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6385
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006386 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006387
6388
6389timeout connect <timeout>
6390timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6391 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6393 yes | no | yes | yes
6394 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006395 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006396 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6397 as explained at the top of this document.
6398
6399 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006400 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006401 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006402 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006403 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6404 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006405
6406 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6407 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6408 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6409 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6410 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6411 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6412
6413 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6414 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6415 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6416
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006417 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6418 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006419
6420
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006421timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6422 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6424 yes | yes | yes | yes
6425 Arguments :
6426 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6427 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6428 as explained at the top of this document.
6429
6430 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6431 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6432 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6433 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6434 once the request has started to present itself.
6435
6436 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6437 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6438 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6439 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6440 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6441
6442 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6443 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6444 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6445 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6446
6447 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6448 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6449 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6450 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6451 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006452 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006453
6454 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6455 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6456 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6457 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6458
6459 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6460
6461
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006462timeout http-request <timeout>
6463 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006465 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006466 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006467 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006468 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6469 as explained at the top of this document.
6470
6471 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6472 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6473 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6474 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6475 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6476 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6477 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6478 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6479
6480 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6481 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006482 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6483 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006484
6485 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6486 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6487 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6488 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6489 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6490
6491 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006492 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6493 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6494 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006495
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006496 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006497
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006498
6499timeout queue <timeout>
6500 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6502 yes | no | yes | yes
6503 Arguments :
6504 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6505 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6506 as explained at the top of this document.
6507
6508 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6509 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6510 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6511 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6512 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6513
6514 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6515 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6516 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6517 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6518
6519 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6520
6521
6522timeout server <timeout>
6523timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6524 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6526 yes | no | yes | yes
6527 Arguments :
6528 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6529 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6530 as explained at the top of this document.
6531
6532 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6533 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6534 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6535 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6536 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6537 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6538 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6539
6540 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6541 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6542 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6543 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6544 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006545 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006546 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006547 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
6548 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
6549 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
6550 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006551
6552 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6553 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6554 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6555 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6556 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6557 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6558
6559 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6560 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6561 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6562
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006563 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006564
6565
6566timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006567 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6569 yes | yes | yes | yes
6570 Arguments :
6571 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6572 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6573 as explained at the top of this document.
6574
6575 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6576 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6577 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6578
6579 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6580 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6581 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6582 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006583 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006584
6585 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6586
6587
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006588timeout tunnel <timeout>
6589 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
6590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6591 yes | no | yes | yes
6592 Arguments :
6593 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6594 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6595 as explained at the top of this document.
6596
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006597 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006598 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
6599 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
6600 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
6601 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
6602 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
6603 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
6604 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
6605 specified.
6606
6607 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6608 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6609 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
6610 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
6611 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
6612
6613 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6614 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6615 forget about it.
6616
6617 Example :
6618 defaults http
6619 option http-server-close
6620 timeout connect 5s
6621 timeout client 30s
6622 timeout client 30s
6623 timeout server 30s
6624 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
6625
6626 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
6627
6628
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006629transparent (deprecated)
6630 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006632 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006633 Arguments : none
6634
6635 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6636 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6637 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6638 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6639 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6640 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6641 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6642 appropriate server.
6643
6644 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6645
6646 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6647 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6648
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006649 See also: "option transparent"
6650
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006651unique-id-format <string>
6652 Generate a unique ID for each request.
6653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6654 yes | yes | yes | no
6655 Arguments :
6656 <string> is a log-format string.
6657
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006658 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
6659 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
6660 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
6661 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006662
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006663 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
6664 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
6665 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
6666 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
6667 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
6668 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
6669 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
6670 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006671
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006672 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
6673 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006674
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006675 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006676
6677 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6678
6679 will generate:
6680
6681 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6682
6683 See also: "unique-id-header"
6684
6685unique-id-header <name>
6686 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
6687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6688 yes | yes | yes | no
6689 Arguments :
6690 <name> is the name of the header.
6691
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006692 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
6693 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006694
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006695 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006696
6697 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6698 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
6699
6700 will generate:
6701
6702 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6703
6704 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006705
6706use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6707use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006708 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6710 no | yes | yes | no
6711 Arguments :
6712 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6713
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006714 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006715
6716 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6717 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6718 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006719 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6720 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6721 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6722 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006723
6724 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6725 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6726 assign the backend.
6727
6728 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6729 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6730 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6731 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6732 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6733 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6734
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006735 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006736 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006737 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6738 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6739 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6740
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006741 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006742
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006743
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006744use-server <server> if <condition>
6745use-server <server> unless <condition>
6746 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
6747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6748 no | no | yes | yes
6749 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006750 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006751
6752 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
6753
6754 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
6755 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
6756 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
6757
6758 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
6759 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
6760 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
6761 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
6762 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
6763 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
6764 matches will assign the server.
6765
6766 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
6767 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
6768 with the next rules until one matches.
6769
6770 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
6771 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6772 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
6773 according to other persistence mechanisms.
6774
6775 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
6776 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
6777 stripped.
6778
6779 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
6780 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
6781 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
6782 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
6783
6784 Example :
6785 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
6786 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
6787 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
6788 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
6789 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
6790 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
6791 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
6792 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
6793 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
6794
6795 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
6796
6797
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010067985. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006799------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006800
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006801The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6802which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6803arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6804settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6805after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6806Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6807address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006808
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006809 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006810 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006811
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006812The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006813
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02006814addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006815 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6816 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6817 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6818 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6819 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006820
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006821 Supported in default-server: No
6822
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006823backup
6824 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6825 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6826 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6827 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6828 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6829 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006830
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006831 Supported in default-server: No
6832
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006833check
6834 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01006835 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
6836 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
6837 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
6838 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
6839 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
6840 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
6841 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
6842 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
6843 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
6844 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006845
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006846 Supported in default-server: No
6847
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006848cookie <value>
6849 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6850 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6851 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6852 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6853 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6854 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6855 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6856
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006857 Supported in default-server: No
6858
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006859disabled
6860 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6861 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6862 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6863 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6864 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6865
6866 Supported in default-server: No
6867
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006868error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006869 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6870 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6871 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006872
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006873 Supported in default-server: Yes
6874
6875 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006876
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006877fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006878 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
6879 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
6880 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
6881
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006882 Supported in default-server: Yes
6883
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006884id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006885 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
6886 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
6887 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006888
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006889 Supported in default-server: No
6890
6891inter <delay>
6892fastinter <delay>
6893downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006894 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
6895 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
6896 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
6897 between checks depending on the server state :
6898
6899 Server state | Interval used
6900 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6901 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
6902 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6903 Transitionally UP (going down), |
6904 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6905 or yet unchecked. |
6906 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6907 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6908 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006909
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006910 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
6911 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
6912 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
6913 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
6914 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
6915 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
6916 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
6917 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
6918 servers.
6919
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006920 Supported in default-server: Yes
6921
6922maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006923 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
6924 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
6925 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
6926 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
6927 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
6928 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
6929 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
6930 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
6931
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006932 Supported in default-server: Yes
6933
6934maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006935 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
6936 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
6937 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
6938 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
6939 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
6940 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
6941 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
6942
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006943 Supported in default-server: Yes
6944
6945minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006946 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
6947 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
6948 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
6949 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
6950 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
6951 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006952 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006953 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006954
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006955 Supported in default-server: Yes
6956
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09006957non-stick
6958 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
6959 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
6960 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
6961
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006962observe <mode>
6963 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
6964 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
6965 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
6966 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
6967 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
6968 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01006969 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006970
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006971 Supported in default-server: No
6972
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006973 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
6974
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006975on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006976 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
6977 Currently, four modes are available:
6978 - fastinter: force fastinter
6979 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
6980 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
6981 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
6982 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
6983
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006984 Supported in default-server: Yes
6985
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006986 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
6987
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09006988on-marked-down <action>
6989 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
6990 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07006991 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
6992 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
6993 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
6994 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
6995 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
6996 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
6997 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
6998 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09006999
7000 Actions are disabled by default
7001
7002 Supported in default-server: Yes
7003
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007004on-marked-up <action>
7005 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
7006 Currently one action is available:
7007 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
7008 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
7009 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
7010 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
7011 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
7012 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
7013 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
7014 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
7015
7016 Actions are disabled by default
7017
7018 Supported in default-server: Yes
7019
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007020port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007021 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
7022 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
7023 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
7024 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
7025 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
7026 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
7027
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007028 Supported in default-server: Yes
7029
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007030redir <prefix>
7031 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
7032 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
7033 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
7034 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
7035 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
7036 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
7037 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
7038 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007039 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007040 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
7041 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
7042 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
7043 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
7044 loop between the client and HAProxy!
7045
7046 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
7047
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007048 Supported in default-server: No
7049
7050rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007051 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
7052 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
7053 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
7054
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007055 Supported in default-server: Yes
7056
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007057send-proxy
7058 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
7059 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
7060 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
7061 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
7062 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
7063 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
7064 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
7065 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
7066 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
7067 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. See also the "accept-proxy"
7068 option of the "bind" keyword.
7069
7070 Supported in default-server: No
7071
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007072slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007073 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
7074 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
7075 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
7076 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
7077 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
7078 parameters :
7079
7080 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
7081 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
7082
7083 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
7084 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
7085 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
7086 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
7087
7088 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
7089 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
7090 seen as failed.
7091
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007092 Supported in default-server: Yes
7093
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007094source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007095source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007096source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007097 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
7098 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
7099 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
7100 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
7101
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007102 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
7103 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
7104 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
7105 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
7106 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
7107 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
7108 server.
7109
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007110 Supported in default-server: No
7111
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007112track [<proxy>/]<server>
7113 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
7114 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
7115 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
7116 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
7117 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
7118
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007119 Supported in default-server: No
7120
7121weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007122 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
7123 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
7124 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02007125 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
7126 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
7127 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
7128 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
7129 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
7130 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007131
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007132 Supported in default-server: Yes
7133
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007134
71356. HTTP header manipulation
7136---------------------------
7137
7138In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
7139response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
7140request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
7141which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
7142against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
7143to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
7144passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
7145headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
7146never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
7147
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007148There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
7149(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
7150rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
7151messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
7152in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007153happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007154add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
7155normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
7156
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007157This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
7158in section 4.2 :
7159
7160 - reqadd <string>
7161 - reqallow <search>
7162 - reqiallow <search>
7163 - reqdel <search>
7164 - reqidel <search>
7165 - reqdeny <search>
7166 - reqideny <search>
7167 - reqpass <search>
7168 - reqipass <search>
7169 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7170 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7171 - reqtarpit <search>
7172 - reqitarpit <search>
7173 - rspadd <string>
7174 - rspdel <search>
7175 - rspidel <search>
7176 - rspdeny <search>
7177 - rspideny <search>
7178 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7179 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7180
7181With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7182is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7183parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7184prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7185Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7186
7187 \t for a tab
7188 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7189 \n for a new line (LF)
7190 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7191 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7192 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7193 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7194 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7195
7196The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7197portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7198above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7199regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
72009 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7201is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7202
7203The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7204after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7205
7206Notes related to these keywords :
7207---------------------------------
7208 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7209 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7210 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7211
7212 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7213 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7214 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7215
7216 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7217 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7218 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7219 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7220 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7221
7222 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7223 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7224 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7225 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7226 useless headers before adding new ones.
7227
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007228 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007229 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7230
7231 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7232 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7233 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7234
7235 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7236 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007237 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007238
7239
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010072407. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7241------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007242
7243The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7244content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7245from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7246simple :
7247
7248 - define test criteria with sets of values
7249 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7250
7251The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7252
7253In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7254
7255 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7256
7257This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7258Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7259and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7260an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7261of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7262
7263ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7264'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7265which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7266
7267There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7268performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7269
7270The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7271
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007272 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7273 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007274 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7275
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007276The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7277specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7278possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007279multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7280be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7281needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7282space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7283match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7284lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7285duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007286to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceding it. For
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007287instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007288
7289 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7290
7291In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7292the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7293case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7294too.
7295
7296Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7297a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7298ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7299
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007300Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007301
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007302 - integers or integer ranges
7303 - strings
7304 - regular expressions
7305 - IP addresses and networks
7306
7307
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020073087.1. Matching integers
7309----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007310
7311Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7312that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7313expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7314may be omitted.
7315
7316For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7317unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7318representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7319
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007320As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7321two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7322instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7323ranges and operators.
7324
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007325For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007326operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7327Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7328of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007329
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007330Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007331
7332 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7333 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7334 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7335 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7336 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7337
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007338For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007339
7340 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7341
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007342This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7343
7344 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7345
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007346
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020073477.2. Matching strings
7348---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007349
7350String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7351exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7352characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7353string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7354to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007355before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007356
7357
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020073587.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7359-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007360
7361Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7362they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7363possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7364passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7365the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007366the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7367match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007368
7369
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020073707.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007371----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007372
7373IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7374netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7375within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007376host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007377difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7378at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7379does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7380parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007381
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007382IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
7383Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
7384trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
7385IPv6 patterns.
7386
7387HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
7388following situations :
7389 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
7390 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
7391 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
7392 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
7393 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
7394 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
7395 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
7396 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
7397 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
7398 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
7399
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007400
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074017.5. Available matching criteria
7402--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007403
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074047.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7405------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007406
7407A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7408analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007409addresses and ports, as well as internal values independent on the stream.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007410
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007411always_false
7412 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7413 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7414
7415always_true
7416 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7417 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7418
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007419avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007420avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007421 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7422 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7423 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7424 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7425 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7426 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7427 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7428 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7429 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7430 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7431 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007432
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007433be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007434be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007435 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7436 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7437 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7438 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7439 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007440
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007441be_id <integer>
7442 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7443 backend it was called.
7444
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007445be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007446be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007447 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7448 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7449 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7450 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7451 sucking of an online dictionary).
7452
7453 Example :
7454 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7455 backend dynamic
7456 mode http
7457 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7458 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007459
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007460connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007461connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007462 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007463 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007464 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7465
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007466 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7467 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007468
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007469 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007470 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7471 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7472 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7473 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7474 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007475 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007476
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007477 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7478 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7479 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7480 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007481
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007482dst <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007483 Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be
7484 used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007485
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007486dst_conn <integer>
7487 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7488 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7489 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7490 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7491 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7492 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7493
7494dst_port <integer>
7495 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7496 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7497
7498fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007499fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007500 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7501 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7502 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7503 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7504 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7505 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7506 criteria.
7507
7508fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007509 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007510 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007511
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007512fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007513fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007514 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7515 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7516 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7517 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7518 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7519 the rate to go down below the limit.
7520
7521 Example :
7522 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7523 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7524 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7525 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7526 frontend mail
7527 bind :25
7528 mode tcp
7529 maxconn 100
7530 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7531 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7532 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7533 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007534
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007535nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007536nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007537 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7538 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7539 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7540 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7541 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007542
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007543queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007544queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007545 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7546 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7547 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7548 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7549 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7550 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7551 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7552
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007553sc1_bytes_in_rate
7554sc2_bytes_in_rate
7555 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7556 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7557 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7558
7559sc1_bytes_out_rate
7560sc2_bytes_out_rate
7561 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7562 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7563 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7564
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007565sc1_clr_gpc0
7566sc2_clr_gpc0
7567 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
7568 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
7569 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
7570 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
7571 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
7572 was verified :
7573
7574 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7575 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7576 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7577 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7578 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
7579 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7580 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7581
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007582sc1_conn_cnt
7583sc2_conn_cnt
7584 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7585 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
7586
7587sc1_conn_cur
7588sc2_conn_cur
7589 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
7590 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
7591 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
7592
7593sc1_conn_rate
7594sc2_conn_rate
7595 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
7596 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
7597 See also src_conn_rate.
7598
7599sc1_get_gpc0
7600sc2_get_gpc0
7601 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7602 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
7603
7604sc1_http_err_cnt
7605sc2_http_err_cnt
7606 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
7607 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
7608 See also src_http_err_cnt.
7609
7610sc1_http_err_rate
7611sc2_http_err_rate
7612 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
7613 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
7614 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
7615 src_http_err_rate.
7616
7617sc1_http_req_cnt
7618sc2_http_req_cnt
7619 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7620 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7621 src_http_req_cnt.
7622
7623sc1_http_req_rate
7624sc2_http_req_rate
7625 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7626 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
7627 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7628 src_http_req_rate.
7629
7630sc1_inc_gpc0
7631sc2_inc_gpc0
7632 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
7633 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
7634 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
7635 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
7636 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
7637 when a first ACL was verified :
7638
7639 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7640 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
7641 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7642
7643sc1_kbytes_in
7644sc2_kbytes_in
7645 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
7646 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7647 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7648 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
7649
7650sc1_kbytes_out
7651sc2_kbytes_out
7652 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
7653 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7654 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7655 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
7656
7657sc1_sess_cnt
7658sc2_sess_cnt
7659 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
7660 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
7661 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
7662 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007663 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007664 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
7665
7666sc1_sess_rate
7667sc2_sess_rate
7668 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
7669 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
7670 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
7671 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
7672 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007673 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007674
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007675so_id <integer>
7676 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
7677
7678src <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007679 Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit
7680 access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level
7681 source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007682
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007683src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007684src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007685 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7686 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7687 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007688 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007689
7690src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007691src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007692 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
7693 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7694 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007695 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007696
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007697src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
7698src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
7699 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7700 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7701 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
7702 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
7703 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
7704 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7705
7706 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7707 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7708 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7709 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7710 acl save src_clr_gpc0
7711 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7712 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7713
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007714src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007715src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007716 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7717 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7718 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007719 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007720
7721src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007722src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007723 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
7724 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
7725 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007726 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007727
7728src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007729src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007730 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
7731 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7732 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007733 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007734
7735src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007736src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007737 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7738 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7739 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007740 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007741
7742src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007743src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007744 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
7745 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7746 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007747 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007748
7749src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007750src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007751 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
7752 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
7753 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
7754 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007755 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007756
7757src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007758src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007759 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7760 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7761 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007762 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007763
7764src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007765src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007766 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7767 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7768 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
7769 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007770 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007771
7772src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007773src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007774 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7775 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7776 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
7777 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
7778 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
7779 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7780
7781 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7782 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007783 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007784
7785src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007786src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007787 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
7788 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7789 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7790 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007791 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007792
7793src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007794src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007795 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
7796 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7797 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7798 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007799 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007800
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007801src_port <integer>
7802 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007803
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007804src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007805src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007806 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7807 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
7808 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
7809 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007810 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007811
7812src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007813src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007814 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7815 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7816 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
7817 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007818 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007819
7820src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007821src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007822 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007823 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
7824 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007825 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
7826 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
7827 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007828 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007829
7830 Example :
7831 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
7832 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
7833 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
7834 listen ssh
7835 bind :22
7836 mode tcp
7837 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007838 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007839 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
7840 server local 127.0.0.1:22
7841
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007842srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02007843 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
7844 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
7845 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
7846 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
7847
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007848srv_id <integer>
7849 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
7850
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02007851srv_is_up(<server>)
7852srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
7853 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
7854 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
7855 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
7856 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
7857 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
7858 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
7859 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
7860 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
7861
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007862table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007863table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007864 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
7865 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
7866
7867table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007868table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007869 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
7870 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
7871 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
7872
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007873
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020078747.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
7875---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007876
7877A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
7878during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007879through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
7880keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007881
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01007882rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7883 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7884 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7885 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
7886 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7887
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007888req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007889 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007890 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
7891 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
7892 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
7893 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
7894 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
7895 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
7896
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007897req_proto_http
7898 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
7899 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007900 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007901 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
7902 using TCP request content inspection rules.
7903
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007904req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007905req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007906 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
7907 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
7908 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
7909 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
7910 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
7911 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
7912 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
7913 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
7914
7915req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007916req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007917 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
7918 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
7919 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
7920 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
7921 cookies.
7922
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01007923req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7924 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7925 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7926 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
7927 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7928
7929req_ssl_sni <string>
7930 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7931 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
7932 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
7933 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
7934 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
7935 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
7936 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
7937 hello (type 1), like in the example below.
7938
7939 Examples :
7940 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
7941 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7942 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
7943 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
7944 default_backend bk_sorry_page
7945
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007946req_ssl_ver <decimal>
7947 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
7948 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
7949 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
7950 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
7951 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
7952 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
7953 with TCP request content inspection.
7954
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02007955wait_end
7956 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
7957 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
7958 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
7959 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
7960 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
7961 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
7962 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
7963 inspection.
7964
7965 Examples :
7966 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
7967 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
7968 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
7969
7970 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
7971 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
7972 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
7973 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
7974 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
7975 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
7976 tcp-request content reject
7977
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007978
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079797.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
7980--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007981
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007982A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007983application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
7984read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
7985than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
7986
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02007987base <string>
7988 Returns true when the concatenation of the first Host header and the path
7989 part of the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the
7990 question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be used to match known
7991 files in virtual hosting environments, such as "www.example.com/favicon.ico".
7992 See also "path" and "uri".
7993
7994base_beg <string>
7995 Returns true when the base (see above) begins with one of the strings. This
7996 can be used to send certain directory names to alternative backends. See also
7997 "path_beg".
7998
7999base_dir <string>
8000 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8001 slashes in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "url_dir" and
8002 "path_dir" instead.
8003
8004base_dom <string>
8005 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8006 in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "path_dom" and "url_dom"
8007 instead.
8008
8009base_end <string>
8010 Returns true when the base (see above) ends with one of the strings. This may
8011 be used to control file name extension, though "path_end" is cheaper.
8012
8013base_len <integer>
8014 Returns true when the base (see above) length matches the values or ranges
8015 specified. This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8016
8017base_reg <regex>
8018 Returns true when the base (see above) matches one of the regular
8019 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8020 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg", "url_reg"
8021 and all "base_" criteria.
8022
8023base_sub <string>
8024 Returns true when the base (see above) contains one of the strings. It can be
8025 used to detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See
8026 also "base_dir".
8027
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008028cook(<name>) <string>
8029 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
8030 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
8031 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
8032 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
8033 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
8034 sent by the server.
8035
8036 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
8037 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
8038 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
8039
8040 cook(profile) silver gold
8041
8042cook_beg(<name>) <string>
8043 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
8044 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8045 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8046
8047cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
8048 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
8049 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
8050 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
8051 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
8052 server.
8053
8054cook_dir(<name>) <string>
8055 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8056 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8057 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
8058 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
8059 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8060
8061cook_dom(<name>) <string>
8062 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8063 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
8064 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8065 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8066
8067cook_end(<name>) <string>
8068 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
8069 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8070 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8071
8072cook_len(<name>) <integer>
8073 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
8074 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8075 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
8076 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
8077 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8078
8079cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
8080 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
8081 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
8082 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
8083 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8084 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8085
8086cook_sub(<name>) <string>
8087 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
8088 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8089 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8090
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02008091cook_val(<name>) <integer>
8092 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which
8093 matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server
8094 based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not
8095 match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8096 scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8097
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008098hdr <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008099hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008100 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
8101 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
8102 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
8103 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008104 If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only
8105 this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from
8106 the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8107 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr()
8108 variant for response headers sent by the server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008109
8110 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008111 match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008112 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
8113
8114 hdr(Connection) -i close
8115
8116hdr_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008117hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008118 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
8119 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
8120 response headers sent by the server.
8121
8122hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008123hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008124 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
8125 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
8126 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
8127 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
8128 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
8129 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
8130 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8131
8132hdr_dir <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008133hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008134 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8135 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8136 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
8137 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
8138 headers sent by the server.
8139
8140hdr_dom <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008141hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008142 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8143 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
8144 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
8145 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
8146 server.
8147
8148hdr_end <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008149hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008150 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
8151 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
8152 response headers sent by the server.
8153
8154hdr_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008155hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address>
8156 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8157 matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For
8158 or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008159 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8160
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008161hdr_len <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008162hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008163 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
8164 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8165 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
8166 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8167
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008168hdr_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008169hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008170 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008171 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
8172 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
8173 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
8174 response headers sent by the server.
8175
8176hdr_sub <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008177hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008178 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
8179 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
8180 response headers sent by the server.
8181
8182hdr_val <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008183hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008184 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
8185 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
8186 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
8187 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8188
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008189http_auth(<userlist>)
8190http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008191 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
8192 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
8193 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
8194 of specified groups.
8195
8196 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
8197
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02008198http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02008199 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
8200 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
8201 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
8202 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
8203
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008204method <string>
8205 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
8206 already check for most common methods.
8207
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008208path <string>
8209 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
8210 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
8211 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
8212
8213path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008214 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
8215 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008216
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008217path_dir <string>
8218 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8219 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8220 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8221 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
8222
8223path_dom <string>
8224 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8225 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
8226 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
8227
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008228path_end <string>
8229 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
8230 control file name extension.
8231
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008232path_len <integer>
8233 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
8234 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8235
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008236path_reg <regex>
8237 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8238 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
8239 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
8240
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008241path_sub <string>
8242 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8243 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
8244 "path_dir".
8245
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +02008246payload(<offset>,<length>) <string>
8247 Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the
8248 request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the
8249 strings.
8250
8251payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
8252 Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
8253 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
8254 the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of
8255 the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
8256 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
8257
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008258req_ver <string>
8259 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
8260 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
8261
8262status <integer>
8263 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
8264 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
8265 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
8266
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008267url <string>
8268 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008269 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL. See also "base".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008270
8271url_beg <string>
8272 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008273 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme. See also
8274 "base_beg".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008275
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008276url_dir <string>
8277 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8278 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8279 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8280 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
8281
8282url_dom <string>
8283 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8284 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
8285 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
8286
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008287url_end <string>
8288 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
8289 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008290
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008291url_ip <address>
8292 Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP
8293 request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local
8294 network. It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008295
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008296url_len <integer>
8297 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
8298 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8299
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008300url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008301 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
8302 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008303 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008304 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008305
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008306url_reg <regex>
8307 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8308 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008309 than other methods. See also "base_reg", "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008310
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008311url_sub <string>
8312 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8313 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008314
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008315urlp(<name>) <string>
8316 Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the
8317 parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive.
8318
8319 The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter
8320 matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values.
8321
8322urlp_beg(<name>) <string>
8323 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings.
8324 This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a
8325 protocol scheme.
8326
8327urlp_dir(<name>) <string>
8328 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings
8329 either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename
8330 or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of
8331 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub".
8332
8333urlp_dom(<name>) <string>
8334 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8335 in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching
8336 in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding
8337 prefixes. See also "urlp_sub".
8338
8339urlp_end(<name>) <string>
8340 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings.
8341
8342urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008343 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8344 which matches one of the specified addresses.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008345
8346urlp_len(<name>) <integer>
8347 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values
8348 or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8349
8350urlp_reg(<name>) <regex>
8351 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular
8352 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8353 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all
8354 "urlp_" criteria.
8355
8356urlp_sub(<name>) <string>
8357 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It
8358 can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See
8359 also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria.
8360
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +02008361urlp_val(<name>) <integer>
8362 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" starts with a number matching
8363 the values or ranges specified. Note that the absence of the parameter does
8364 not match anything. Integers are unsigned so it is not possible to match
8365 negative data.
8366
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008367
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083687.6. Pre-defined ACLs
8369---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008370
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008371Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
8372every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008373order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008374
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008375ACL name Equivalent to Usage
8376---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008377FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008378HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008379HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
8380HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008381HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
8382HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
8383HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
8384HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
8385LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008386METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
8387METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
8388METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
8389METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
8390METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
8391METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008392RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008393REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008394TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008395WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
8396---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008397
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008398
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083997.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
8400----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008401
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008402Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
8403combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008405 - AND (implicit)
8406 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
8407 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008408
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008409A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008410
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008411 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008412
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008413Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
8414indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008415
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008416For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
8417"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
8418requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
8419is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008420
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008421 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8422 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
8423 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
8424 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008425
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008426To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
8427and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008428
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008429 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8430 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8431 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
8432 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008434 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
8435 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
8436 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
8437 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008438
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01008439It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
8440expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
8441be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008442the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01008443
8444 The following rule :
8445
8446 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8447 block if METH_POST missing_cl
8448
8449 Can also be written that way :
8450
8451 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
8452
8453It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
8454to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
8455simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
8456sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
8457good use is the following :
8458
8459 With named ACLs :
8460
8461 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8462 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8463 monitor fail if site_dead
8464
8465 With anonymous ACLs :
8466
8467 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
8468
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008469See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008470
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01008471
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010084727.8. Pattern extraction
8473-----------------------
8474
8475The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
8476response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
8477for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
8478
8479All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
8480"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
8481begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
8482arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
8483much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
8484equivalent used in ACLs.
8485
8486The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
8487
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008488 base This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the
8489 path part of the request, which starts at the first slash and
8490 ends before the question mark. It can be useful in virtual
8491 hosted environments to detect URL abuses as well as to improve
8492 shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size stick
8493 table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
8494 requested objects by host/path.
8495
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008496 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008497 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8498 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8499 according to RFC 4291.
8500
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008501 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
8502 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
8503 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008504 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8505 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8506 according to RFC 4291.
8507
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008508 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
8509 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
8510 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
8511 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
8512 type integer and only works with such tables.
8513
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008514 hdr(<name>[,<occ>])
8515 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
8516 request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as
8517 a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
8518 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
8519 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the
8520 last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01008521 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02008522
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02008523 path This extracts the request's URL path (without the host part). A
8524 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
8525 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
8526 keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing caches, it would be
8527 wiser to use "url" instead.
8528
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008529 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008530 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
8531 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
8532 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
8533 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008534
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008535 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008536 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
8537 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
8538 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
8539 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
8540 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
8541 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
8542 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
8543 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008544
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008545 src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side,
8546 which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely
8547 that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost.
8548 It is of type integer and only works with such tables.
8549
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02008550 url This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A
8551 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
8552 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
8553 keep them in caches. See also "path".
8554
8555 url_ip This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the
8556 host part is presented as an IP address. Its use is very
8557 limited. For instance, a monitoring system might use this field
8558 as an alternative for the source IP in order to test what path a
8559 given source address would follow, or to force an entry in a
8560 table for a given source address.
8561
8562 url_port This extracts the port part from the request's URL. It probably
8563 is totally useless but it was available at no cost.
8564
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008565 url_param(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008566 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
8567 the query string of the request and uses the corresponding value
8568 to match. A typical use is to get sticky session through url
8569 (e.g. http://example.com/foo?JESSIONID=some_id with
8570 url_param(JSESSIONID)), for cases where cookies cannot be used.
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09008571
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008572 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008573 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
8574 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
8575 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
8576 done if there is no msts cookie present.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008577
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008578 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
8579 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
8580 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
8581 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
8582 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
8583 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
8584 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008585
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008586 Example :
8587 listen tse-farm
8588 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
8589 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8590 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8591 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8592 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8593 persist rdp-cookie
8594 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
8595 # This is only useful makes sense if
8596 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
8597 stick-table type string size 204800
8598 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
8599 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8600 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008601
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008602 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
8603 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008604
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008605 cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008606 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02008607 "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header
8608 from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A
8609 typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile
8610 use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession"
8611 does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
8612 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008613
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008614 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008615
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008616 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02008617 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the
8618 "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and
8619 responses. This keyword will disappear soon.
8620
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008621 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
8622 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
8623 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
8624 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
8625 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008626
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008627 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008628
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008629
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008630The currently available list of transformations include :
8631
8632 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
8633 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8634 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8635
8636 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
8637 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8638 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8639
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008640 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01008641 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
8642 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
8643 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
8644 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
8645
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008646
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086478. Logging
8648----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008649
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008650One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
8651provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
8652very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
8653provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
8654state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008655to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008656headers.
8657
8658In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
8659about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
8660send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
8661
8662 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
8663 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
8664 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
8665 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
8666 at the termination.
8667
8668The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
8669allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
8670as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
8671while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
8672real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
8673delay.
8674
8675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086768.1. Log levels
8677---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008678
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008679TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008680source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008681HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
8682in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
8683track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
8684syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
8685about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008686
8687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086888.2. Log formats
8689----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008690
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008691HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008692and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
8693slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
8694options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008695
8696 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
8697 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
8698 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
8699 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
8700 extents.
8701
8702 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
8703 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
8704 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
8705 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
8706 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
8707
8708 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
8709 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
8710 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
8711 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
8712 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
8713
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008714 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
8715 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
8716 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
8717 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
8718
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008719 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
8720
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008721Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
8722specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
8723field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
8724servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
8725always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
8726identifier.
8727
8728Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
8729 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
8730 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
8731 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
8732 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
8733
8734
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020087358.2.1. Default log format
8736-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008737
8738This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
8739as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
8740format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
8741
8742 Example :
8743 listen www
8744 mode http
8745 log global
8746 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8747
8748 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
8749 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
8750 (www/HTTP)
8751
8752 Field Format Extract from the example above
8753 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
8754 2 'Connect from' Connect from
8755 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
8756 4 'to' to
8757 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
8758 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
8759
8760Detailed fields description :
8761 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
8762 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
8763 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
8764 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
8765 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8766 and processed the connection.
8767 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
8768
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008769In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
8770"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
8771connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
8772
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008773It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
8774will eventually disappear.
8775
8776
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020087778.2.2. TCP log format
8778---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008779
8780The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
8781is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
8782information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
8783counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
8784emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
8785environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
8786the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
8787sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008788specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
8789not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
8790fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
8791marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008792
8793 Example :
8794 frontend fnt
8795 mode tcp
8796 option tcplog
8797 log global
8798 default_backend bck
8799
8800 backend bck
8801 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8802
8803 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
8804 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
8805 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
8806
8807 Field Format Extract from the example above
8808 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
8809 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
8810 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
8811 4 frontend_name fnt
8812 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
8813 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
8814 7 bytes_read* 212
8815 8 termination_state --
8816 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
8817 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8818
8819Detailed fields description :
8820 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008821 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8822 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8823 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8824 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8825 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008826
8827 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008828 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8829 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8830 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008831
8832 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
8833 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
8834 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
8835 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
8836
8837 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8838 and processed the connection.
8839
8840 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8841 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8842 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
8843 applications.
8844
8845 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8846 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8847 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8848 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
8849 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
8850
8851 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8852 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8853 See "Timers" below for more details.
8854
8855 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8856 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8857 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
8858 "Timers" below for more details.
8859
8860 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8861 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8862 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8863 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8864 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8865 details.
8866
8867 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
8868 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
8869 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
8870 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
8871 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
8872
8873 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8874 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8875 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
8876 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
8877 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
8878 for more details.
8879
8880 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008881 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008882 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
8883 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
8884 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008885 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008886
8887 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8888 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8889 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8890 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8891 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8892 caused by a denial of service attack.
8893
8894 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8895 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8896 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8897 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8898 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8899 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8900 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8901 denial of service attack.
8902
8903 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8904 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8905 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8906 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8907 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8908 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8909 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8910 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
8911 be processed than on other servers.
8912
8913 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8914 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8915 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8916 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8917 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8918 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8919 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8920 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8921 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8922 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8923 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8924 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8925 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8926
8927 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8928 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8929 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8930 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8931 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8932 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8933 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8934 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8935
8936 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8937 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8938 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8939 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8940 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8941 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8942 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8943 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8944 occurs.
8945
8946
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089478.2.3. HTTP log format
8948----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008949
8950The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
8951is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
8952the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
8953are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
8954emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
8955generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
8956"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
8957which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008958frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
8959is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008960
8961Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
8962slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
8963with a star ('*') after the field name below.
8964
8965 Example :
8966 frontend http-in
8967 mode http
8968 option httplog
8969 log global
8970 default_backend bck
8971
8972 backend static
8973 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8974
8975 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8976 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8977 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008978 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008979
8980 Field Format Extract from the example above
8981 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
8982 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
8983 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
8984 4 frontend_name http-in
8985 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
8986 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
8987 7 status_code 200
8988 8 bytes_read* 2750
8989 9 captured_request_cookie -
8990 10 captured_response_cookie -
8991 11 termination_state ----
8992 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
8993 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8994 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
8995 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
8996 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008997
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008998
8999Detailed fields description :
9000 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009001 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9002 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9003 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9004 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9005 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009006
9007 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009008 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9009 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9010 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009011
9012 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
9013 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
9014 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
9015 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
9016 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
9017
9018 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9019 and processed the connection.
9020
9021 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9022 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9023 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
9024
9025 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9026 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9027 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9028 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
9029 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
9030 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
9031
9032 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
9033 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
9034 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
9035 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
9036 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
9037 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
9038
9039 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9040 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9041 See "Timers" below for more details.
9042
9043 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9044 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9045 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
9046 below for more details.
9047
9048 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
9049 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
9050 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
9051 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
9052 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
9053 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
9054 for more details.
9055
9056 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9057 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9058 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9059 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9060 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9061 details.
9062
9063 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
9064 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
9065 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
9066
9067 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
9068 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
9069 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
9070 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
9071 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
9072 overflowing.
9073
9074 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
9075 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
9076 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
9077 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
9078 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
9079 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
9080 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
9081 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9082
9083 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
9084 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
9085 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
9086 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
9087 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
9088 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
9089 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
9090 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9091
9092 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9093 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9094 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
9095 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
9096 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
9097 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
9098 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
9099
9100 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009101 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009102 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
9103 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
9104 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009105 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009106 system.
9107
9108 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9109 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9110 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9111 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9112 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9113 caused by a denial of service attack.
9114
9115 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9116 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9117 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9118 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9119 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9120 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9121 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9122 denial of service attack.
9123
9124 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9125 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9126 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9127 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9128 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9129 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9130 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9131 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
9132 processed than on other servers.
9133
9134 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9135 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9136 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9137 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9138 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9139 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9140 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9141 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9142 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9143 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9144 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9145 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9146 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9147
9148 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9149 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9150 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9151 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9152 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9153 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9154 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9155 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9156
9157 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9158 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9159 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9160 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9161 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9162 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9163 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9164 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9165 occurs.
9166
9167 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
9168 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
9169 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
9170 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
9171 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
9172 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
9173 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
9174 cookies" below for more details.
9175
9176 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
9177 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
9178 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
9179 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
9180 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
9181 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
9182 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
9183 and cookies" below for more details.
9184
9185 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
9186 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
9187 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
9188 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
9189 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
9190 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
9191 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
9192 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
9193
9194
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020091958.2.4. Custom log format
9196------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009197
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009198The directive log-format allows you to custom the logs in http mode and tcp
9199mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009200
9201HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
9202Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
9203separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
9204prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
9205
9206Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
9207variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
9208string formats ("Q").
9209
9210Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
9211HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
9212
9213Flags are :
9214 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009215 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009216
9217 Example:
9218
9219 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
9220 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
9221
9222At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
9223
9224 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %st\ %B\ %cc\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009225 %cs\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009226
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009227the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009228
9229 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}Ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %st\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %Cp\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009230 %ms\ %f\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009231 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %cc\ %cs\ \%hrl\ %hsl
9232
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009233and the default TCP format is defined this way :
9234
9235 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
9236 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
9237
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009238Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
9239
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009240 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9241 | H | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
9242 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9243 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
9244 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9245 | | %B | bytes_read | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009246 | | %Ci | client_ip | IP |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009247 | | %Cp | client_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009248 | | %Bi | backend_source_ip | IP |
William Lallemandb7ff6a32012-03-02 14:35:21 +01009249 | | %Bp | backend_source_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009250 | | %Fi | frontend_ip | IP |
9251 | | %Fp | frontend_port | numeric |
9252 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009253 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009254 | | %Si | server_IP | IP |
9255 | | %Sp | server_port | numeric |
9256 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009257 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
9258 | * | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
9259 | * | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009260 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009261 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
9262 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
9263 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
9264 | | %b | backend_name | string |
9265 | | %bc | beconn | numeric |
9266 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
9267 | * | %cc | captured_request_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009268 | * | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009269 | * | %cs | captured_response_cookie | string |
9270 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
9271 | | %fc | feconn | numeric |
9272 | * | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
9273 | * | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
9274 | * | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
9275 | * | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
9276 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009277 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009278 | * | %r | http_request | string |
9279 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
9280 | | %s | server_name | string |
9281 | | %sc | srv_conn | numeric |
9282 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
9283 | * | %st | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009284 | | %t | date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009285 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009286 | * | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009287 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009288
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009289*: mode http only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009290
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092918.3. Advanced logging options
9292-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009293
9294Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
9295just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
9296options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
9297for more information about their usage.
9298
9299
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093008.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
9301------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009302
9303It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
9304haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
9305commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
9306monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
9307ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
9308
9309 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
9310 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
9311 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
9312 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
9313
9314 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
9315 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
9316 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
9317 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
9318 such as other load-balancers.
9319
9320 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
9321 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
9322 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
9323
9324
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093258.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
9326----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009327
9328The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
9329what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
9330or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
9331"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
9332just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
9333log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
9334after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
9335is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
9336with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
9337with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
9338
9339
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093408.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
9341------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009342
9343Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
9344for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
9345"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
9346retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
9347raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
9348a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
9349file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
9350you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
9351"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
9352
9353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093548.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
9355--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009356
9357Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
9358multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
9359them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
9360"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
9361logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
9362error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
9363and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
9364too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
9365useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
9366alternative.
9367
9368
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093698.4. Timing events
9370------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009371
9372Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
9373reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
9374the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
9375frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
9376mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
9377
9378 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
9379 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
9380 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
9381 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
9382 the client closes prematurely or times out.
9383
9384 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
9385 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
9386 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
9387 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
9388 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
9389
9390 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
9391 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
9392 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
9393 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
9394 connection never established.
9395
9396 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
9397 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
9398 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
9399 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
9400 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
9401 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
9402 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
9403 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
9404 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
9405 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
9406 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
9407
9408 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
9409 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
9410 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
9411 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
9412 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
9413
9414 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
9415
9416 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
9417 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
9418 negative.
9419
9420These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
9421protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
9422that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009423due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009424close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
9425session has been aborted on timeout.
9426
9427Most common cases :
9428
9429 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
9430 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
9431 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
9432 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
9433 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
9434 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
9435 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
9436 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
9437 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02009438 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
9439 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
9440 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009441
9442 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
9443 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
9444 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
9445 of ms on remote networks.
9446
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009447 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
9448 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
9449 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009450
9451 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
9452 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
9453 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
9454 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
9455 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
9456 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
9457 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
9458 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
9459 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
9460 to the server until another one is released.
9461
9462Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
9463
9464 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
9465 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
9466 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
9467
9468 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
9469 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
9470 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
9471
9472 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
9473 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
9474 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
9475 flags.
9476
9477 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
9478 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
9479 Check the session termination flags, then check the
9480 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
9481 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
9482 the client connection was maintained open.
9483
9484 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
9485 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
9486 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
9487 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
9488
9489
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094908.5. Session state at disconnection
9491-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009492
9493TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
9494"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
94952-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
9496each of which has a special meaning :
9497
9498 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
9499 session to terminate :
9500
9501 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
9502
9503 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
9504 server explicitly refused it.
9505
9506 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
9507 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
9508 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
9509 error in server response which might have caused information leak
9510 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
9511 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
9512
9513 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
9514 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
9515 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
9516 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
9517 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
9518
9519 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
9520 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
9521 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
9522 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
9523 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
9524
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +09009525 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
9526 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
9527
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009528 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
9529 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
9530 backup connections when going up.
9531
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +02009532 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
9533
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009534 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
9535 send or receive data.
9536
9537 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
9538 send or receive data.
9539
9540 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
9541 with nothing left in the buffers.
9542
9543 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
9544
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01009545 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009546 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
9547
9548 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
9549 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
9550 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
9551 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
9552 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
9553
9554 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
9555 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
9556
9557 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
9558 server (HTTP only).
9559
9560 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
9561
9562 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
9563 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
9564 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
9565
9566 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
9567 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
9568 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
9569
9570 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
9571
9572 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
9573 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
9574
9575 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
9576 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
9577 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
9578
9579 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
9580 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02009581 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
9582 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009583
9584 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
9585 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
9586 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
9587 another server.
9588
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009589 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009590 server.
9591
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009592 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
9593 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
9594 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
9595 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9596
9597 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
9598 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
9599 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
9600 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9601
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +02009602 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
9603 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
9604 "use-server" rule).
9605
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009606 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9607
9608 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
9609 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
9610
9611 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
9612
9613 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
9614 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
9615 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
9616
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009617 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
9618 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
9619 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
9620 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
9621 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
9622
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009623 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
9624
9625 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
9626 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
9627
9628 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
9629
9630 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9631
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009632The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
9633was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009634helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
9635starvation, attacks, etc...
9636
9637The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
9638alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
9639easier finding and understanding.
9640
9641 Flags Reason
9642
9643 -- Normal termination.
9644
9645 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
9646 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
9647 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
9648 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
9649
9650 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
9651 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
9652 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
9653 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
9654 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
9655 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009656
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009657 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9658 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009659 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009660
9661 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
9662 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
9663 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
9664
9665 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
9666 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
9667 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
9668 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
9669 the server takes too long to respond.
9670
9671 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
9672 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
9673 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
9674 long a time to respond.
9675
9676 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
9677 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
9678 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
9679 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
9680 and the client.
9681
9682 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
9683 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
9684 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
9685 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
9686 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
9687 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
9688
9689 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
9690 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009691 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
9692 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
9693 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
9694 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009695
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009696 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009697 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
9698 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
9699 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
9700 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
9701 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
9702
9703 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
9704 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
9705 503 or 504 here.
9706
9707 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
9708 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
9709 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
9710 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
9711 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
9712
9713 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9714 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009715 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009716 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
9717 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
9718
9719 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
9720 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
9721 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
9722 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
9723 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
9724 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
9725 between haproxy and the server.
9726
9727 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
9728 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
9729 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
9730 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
9731 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
9732 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
9733 solution is to fix the application.
9734
9735 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
9736 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
9737 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
9738 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
9739 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
9740 external attacks.
9741
9742 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
9743 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009744 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009745 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
9746 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
9747
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009748 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
9749 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
9750 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
9751 the client.
9752
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009753 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
9754 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
9755 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
9756 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009757 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
9758 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
9759 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
9760 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
9761 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009762
9763 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
9764 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
9765 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
9766 returned an HTTP 403 error.
9767
9768 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
9769 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
9770 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
9771 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
9772
9773 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
9774 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
9775 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
9776 only be solved by proper system tuning.
9777
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009778The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
9779persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
9780important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
9781re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
9782
9783 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
9784
9785 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9786 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
9787 set on a GET request.
9788
9789 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
9790 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009791 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009792 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
9793
9794 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
9795 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
9796 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
9797
9798 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9799 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
9800 already got a cookie.
9801
9802 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9803 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
9804 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
9805 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
9806 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
9807
9808 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9809 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9810 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9811
9812 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
9813 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9814 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9815
9816 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
9817 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
9818
9819 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
9820 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
9821 then advertised in the response.
9822
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009823
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098248.6. Non-printable characters
9825-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009826
9827In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
9828consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
9829converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
9830prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
9831being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
9832escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
9833is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
9834'}' when logging headers.
9835
9836Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
9837issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
9838containing spaces is "User-Agent".
9839
9840Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
9841the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
9842performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
9843
9844
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098458.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
9846---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009847
9848Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
9849achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009850section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009851cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
9852the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
9853the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009854locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009855not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
9856user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
9857a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
9858wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
9859
9860 Examples :
9861 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
9862 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
9863
9864 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
9865 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
9866
9867
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098688.8. Capturing HTTP headers
9869---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009870
9871Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
9872proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
9873the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
9874server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
9875
9876Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
9877response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009878section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009879
9880It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009881time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
9882appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009883are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
9884and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
9885follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
9886request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
9887in the logs.
9888
9889 Example :
9890 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
9891 listen proxy-out
9892 mode http
9893 option httplog
9894 option logasap
9895 log global
9896 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
9897
9898 # log the name of the virtual server
9899 capture request header Host len 20
9900
9901 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
9902 capture request header Content-Length len 10
9903
9904 # log the beginning of the referrer
9905 capture request header Referer len 20
9906
9907 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
9908 capture response header Server len 20
9909
9910 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
9911 capture response header Content-Length len 10
9912
9913 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
9914 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
9915
9916 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
9917 capture response header Via len 20
9918
9919 # log the URL location during a redirection
9920 capture response header Location len 20
9921
9922 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
9923 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
9924 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9925 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
9926 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
9927
9928 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9929 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9930 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9931 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009932 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009933
9934 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9935 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9936 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9937 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
9938 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009939 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009940
9941
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020099428.9. Examples of logs
9943---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009944
9945These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
9946them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
9947reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
9948
9949 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
9950 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9951 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9952
9953 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
9954 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
9955
9956 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
9957 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
9958 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9959
9960 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
9961 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
9962
9963 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
9964 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9965 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9966
9967 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009968 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009969 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
9970 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
9971
9972 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
9973 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
9974 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
9975
9976 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
9977 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009978 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009979 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
9980 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
9981 to return the 502 and not the server.
9982
9983 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009984 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009985
9986 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
9987 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
9988 Nothing was sent to any server.
9989
9990 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
9991 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
9992
9993 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
9994 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
9995 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
9996 send a 408 return code to the client.
9997
9998 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
9999 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
10000
10001 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
10002 5 seconds ("c----").
10003
10004 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
10005 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010006 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010007
10008 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010009 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010010 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
10011 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
10012 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
10013 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
10014 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010015
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010016
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200100179. Statistics and monitoring
10018----------------------------
10019
10020It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
10021mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
10022CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
10023Unix socket.
10024
10025
100269.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010027---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010028
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010010029The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
10030page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
10031
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010032 0. pxname: proxy name
10033 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
10034 for server)
10035 2. qcur: current queued requests
10036 3. qmax: max queued requests
10037 4. scur: current sessions
10038 5. smax: max sessions
10039 6. slim: sessions limit
10040 7. stot: total sessions
10041 8. bin: bytes in
10042 9. bout: bytes out
10043 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010044 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010045 12. ereq: request errors
10046 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010047 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010048 15. wretr: retries (warning)
10049 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010010050 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010051 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
10052 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
10053 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
10054 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
10055 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
10056 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
10057 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
10058 25. qlimit: queue limit
10059 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
10060 27. iid: unique proxy id
10061 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
10062 29. throttle: warm up status
10063 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
10064 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010065 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020010066 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
10067 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
10068 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010069 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010070 UNK -> unknown
10071 INI -> initializing
10072 SOCKERR -> socket error
10073 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
10074 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
10075 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
10076 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
10077 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
10078 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10079 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10080 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
10081 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
10082 disable-on-404
10083 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10084 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10085 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010086 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
10087 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010088 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
10089 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
10090 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
10091 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
10092 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
10093 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010094 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
10095 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
10096 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
10097 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010098 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
10099 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010100
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010101
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101029.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010103-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010104
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010105The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010106must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
10107is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
10108a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
10109risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
10110followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
10111given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
10112then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
10113to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010114
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010115It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
10116on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
10117own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010118
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010119clear counters
10120 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
10121 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
10122 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
10123 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
10124 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10125
10126clear counters all
10127 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
10128 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
10129 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
10130
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010131clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
10132 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
10133
10134 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
10135 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
10136 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
10137 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
10138 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
10139 later after the session ends is usual enough.
10140
10141 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
10142
10143 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
10144 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
10145 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
10146 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
10147 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
10148 the ACLs :
10149
10150 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10151 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10152 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10153 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10154 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10155 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10156
10157 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010158 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
10159 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010160
10161 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010162 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010163 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010164 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10165 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10166 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10167 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010168
10169 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10170
10171 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010172 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010173 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10174 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010175 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10176 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10177 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010178
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010179disable frontend <frontend>
10180 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
10181 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
10182 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
10183 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
10184 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
10185 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
10186 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
10187 on the stats page.
10188
10189 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10190 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10191
10192 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10193 level "admin".
10194
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010195disable server <backend>/<server>
10196 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
10197 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
10198 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
10199 during the maintenance.
10200
10201 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
10202 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
10203
10204 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010205 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010206
10207 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10208 level "admin".
10209
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010210enable frontend <frontend>
10211 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
10212 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
10213 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
10214 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
10215 which was disabled.
10216
10217 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10218 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10219
10220 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10221 level "admin".
10222
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010223enable server <backend>/<server>
10224 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
10225 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
10226
10227 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010228 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010229
10230 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10231 level "admin".
10232
10233get weight <backend>/<server>
10234 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
10235 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
10236 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
10237 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
10238 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010239 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010240
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010241help
10242 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
10243 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010244
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010245prompt
10246 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
10247 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
10248 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
10249 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
10250 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
10251 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
10252 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
10253 command.
10254
10255quit
10256 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010257
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020010258set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
10259 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any non-null
10260 positive value is allowed, but setting values larger than the global maxconn
10261 does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections were
10262 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
10263 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
10264 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
10265 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10266
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020010267set maxconn global <maxconn>
10268 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
10269 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
10270 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
10271 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
10272 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
10273 setting.
10274
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020010275set rate-limit connections global <value>
10276 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
10277 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
10278 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
10279 is passed in number of connections per second.
10280
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020010281set table <table> key <key> data.<data_type> <value>
10282 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
10283 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
10284 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
10285 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
10286 IP address or affect its quality of service.
10287
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010288set timeout cli <delay>
10289 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
10290 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
10291 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
10292
10293set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
10294 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
10295 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
10296 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
10297 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
10298 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
10299 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
10300 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
10301 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
10302 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
10303 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
10304 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
10305 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
10306 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010307 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010308
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010309show errors [<iid>]
10310 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
10311 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020010312 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
10313 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
10314 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010315
10316 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
10317 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
10318 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
10319 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
10320 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
10321 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
10322 are reported too.
10323
10324 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
10325 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
10326 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
10327 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
10328 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
10329 code.
10330
10331 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
10332 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
10333 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
10334 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
10335 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
10336 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
10337 line.
10338
10339 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010340 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10341 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010342 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
10343 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
10344
10345 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
10346 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
10347 00038 Location: blah\r\n
10348 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
10349 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
10350 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
10351 00204+ minal\r\n
10352 00211 \r\n
10353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010354 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010355 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
10356 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
10357 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
10358 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
10359 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
10360 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010361
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010362show info
10363 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
10364
10365show sess
10366 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020010367 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
10368 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10369
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010010370show sess <id>
10371 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
10372 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10373 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
10374 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
10375 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
10376 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010377
10378show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
10379 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
10380 possible to dump only selected items :
10381 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
10382 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
10383 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
10384 for example:
10385 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
10386 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
10387 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
10388
10389 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010390 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
10391 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010392 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
10393 Release_date: 2009/09/23
10394 Nbproc: 1
10395 Process_num: 1
10396 (...)
10397
10398 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
10399 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
10400 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
10401 (...)
10402 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
10403
10404 $
10405
10406 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
10407 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
10408 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
10409 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010410 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010411
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010412show table
10413 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
10414 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
10415 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
10416 entries currently in use.
10417
10418 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010419 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010420 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
10421 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010422
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010423show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010424 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
10425 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
10426 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010427 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
10428
10429 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
10430 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
10431 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
10432 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
10433 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
10434
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010435 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10436 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10437 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10438 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10439 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10440 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10441
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010442
10443 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010444 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
10445 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010446
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010447 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010448 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010449 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010450 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10451 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10452 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10453 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010454
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010455 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010456 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010457 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10458 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010459
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010460 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
10461 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010462 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010463 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10464 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010465
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010466 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
10467 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010468 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010469 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10470 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
10471
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010472 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
10473 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
10474 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
10475 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
10476 time goes, the average event rate drops.
10477
10478 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
10479 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
10480 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010481 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
10482 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010483 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
10484 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020010485
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010486shutdown frontend <frontend>
10487 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
10488 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
10489 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
10490 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
10491 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
10492 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
10493 once it is terminated.
10494
10495 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10496 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10497
10498 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10499 level "admin".
10500
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020010501shutdown session <id>
10502 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
10503 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10504 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
10505 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
10506 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
10507 flag in the logs.
10508
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020010509shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
10510 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
10511 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
10512 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
10513 'K' flag in the logs.
10514
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010515/*
10516 * Local variables:
10517 * fill-column: 79
10518 * End:
10519 */